blob: ed3fcab1444ae139bc5599236673c112fe53827e [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaucd069922015-02-01 07:54:32 +01005 version 1.5.11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaucd069922015-02-01 07:54:32 +01007 2015/02/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200500 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100501 - tune.zlib.memlevel
502 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504 * Debugging
505 - debug
506 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200507
508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005093.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200510------------------------------------
511
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200512ca-base <dir>
513 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200514 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
515 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517chroot <jail dir>
518 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
519 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
520 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
521 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
522 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
523 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100524
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100525cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
526 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
527 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
528 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100529 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
530 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
531 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
532 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
533 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
534 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
535 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
536 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
537 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
538 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100539
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200540crt-base <dir>
541 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
542 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
543 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
544
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545daemon
546 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
547 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
548 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
549
550gid <number>
551 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
552 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
553 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100554 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
555 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100557
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558group <group name>
559 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
560 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100561
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200562log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
564 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100565 configured with "log global".
566
567 <address> can be one of:
568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100569 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100570 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
571 port).
572
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100573 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
574 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
575 port).
576
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100577 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
578 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
579 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
580 writeable).
581
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100582 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
583 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
584 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
585 in Bourne shell.
586
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200587 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
588 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
589 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
590 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
591 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
592 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
593 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
594 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
595 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
596 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
597 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
598
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100599 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600
601 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
602 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
603 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
604
605 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200606 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
607 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
608 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
609 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
610 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
611 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200613 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100615log-send-hostname [<string>]
616 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
617 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
618 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
619 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
620 the logs.
621
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000622log-tag <string>
623 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
624 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
625 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
626 running on the same host.
627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200628nbproc <number>
629 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
630 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
631 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
632 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
633 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
634
635pidfile <pidfile>
636 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
637 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
638 starting the process. See also "daemon".
639
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100640stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200641 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
642 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
643 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
644 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
645 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
646 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100647 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200648 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
649 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200650
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100651ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
652 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
653 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300654 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100655 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
656 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
657 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
658 "bind" keyword for more information.
659
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100660ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
662 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
663 keyword to see available options.
664
665 Example:
666 global
667 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
668
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100669ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
670 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
671 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300672 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100673 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
674 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
675 information.
676
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100677ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
678 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
679 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
680 keyword to see available options.
681
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100682ssl-server-verify [none|required]
683 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
684 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
685 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
686
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200687stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
688 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
689 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
690 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
691 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200692
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200693 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
694 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
695 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200696
697stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
698 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
699 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100700 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200701
702stats maxconn <connections>
703 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
704 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
705
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706uid <number>
707 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
708 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
709 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
710 one. See also "gid" and "user".
711
712ulimit-n <number>
713 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
714 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
715 option.
716
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100717unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
718 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
719
720 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
721 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
722 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
723 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
724 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
725 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
726 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
727 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
728 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
729 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731user <user name>
732 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
733 See also "uid" and "group".
734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200735node <name>
736 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
737
738 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
739 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
740 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
741 traffic.
742
743description <text>
744 Add a text that describes the instance.
745
746 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
747 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
748 "<" and ">" characters.
749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007513.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200752-----------------------
753
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200754max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
755 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
756 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
757 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
758 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
759 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
760 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
761 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
762 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
763
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200764maxconn <number>
765 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
766 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
767 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200768 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
769 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
770 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
771 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
772 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200773
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200774maxconnrate <number>
775 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
776 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
777 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
778 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
779 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
780 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
781 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
782 fairness.
783
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100784maxcomprate <number>
785 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300786 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100787 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
788 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
789 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
790 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
791 default value.
792
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100793maxcompcpuusage <number>
794 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
795 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
796 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
797 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
798 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
799 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
800 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
801 process down and from introducing high latencies.
802
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100803maxpipes <number>
804 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
805 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
806 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
807 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
808 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
809 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
810
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200811maxsessrate <number>
812 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
813 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
814 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
815 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
816 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
817 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
818 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
819 fairness.
820
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200821maxsslconn <number>
822 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
823 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
824 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
825 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
826 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
827 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
828 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
829
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200830maxsslrate <number>
831 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
832 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
833 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
834 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
835 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
836 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
837 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
838 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
839 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
840 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
841
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100842maxzlibmem <number>
843 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
844 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
845 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100846 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
847 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
848 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
849
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200850noepoll
851 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
852 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100853 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200854
855nokqueue
856 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
857 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
858 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
859
860nopoll
861 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
862 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100863 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100864 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200865
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100866nosplice
867 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
868 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
869 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100870 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100871 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
872 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
873 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
874 "option splice-response".
875
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300876nogetaddrinfo
877 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
878 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
879
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200880spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900881 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
882 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
883 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
884 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
885 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
886 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200887
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200888tune.bufsize <number>
889 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
890 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
891 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
892 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
893 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
894 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
895 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
896 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400897 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
898 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
899 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200900
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200901tune.chksize <number>
902 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
903 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
904 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
905 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
906 checks whenever possible.
907
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100908tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
909 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
910 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
911 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
912 this value. The default value is 1.
913
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100914tune.http.cookielen <number>
915 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
916 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
917 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
918 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
919 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
920 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
921 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
922 to change this value.
923
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200924tune.http.maxhdr <number>
925 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
926 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
927 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
928 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
929 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
930 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
931 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
932 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
933 limit too high.
934
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100935tune.idletimer <timeout>
936 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
937 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
938 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
939 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
940 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
941 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
942 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
943 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
944 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
945
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100946tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100947 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
948 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
949 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
950 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
951 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
952 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
953 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
954 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
955 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
956 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100957
958tune.maxpollevents <number>
959 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
960 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
961 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
962 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
963 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
964
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200965tune.maxrewrite <number>
966 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
967 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
968 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
969 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
970 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
971 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
972 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
973 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
974 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
975 bufsize.
976
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200977tune.pipesize <number>
978 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
979 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
980 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
981 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
982 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
983 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
984
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100985tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
986tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
987 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
988 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
989 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
990 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
991 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
992 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
993 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
994
995tune.sndbuf.client <number>
996tune.sndbuf.server <number>
997 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
998 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
999 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1000 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1001 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1002 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1003 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1004 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1005 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1006 notifying haproxy again.
1007
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001008tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001009 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1010 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1011 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001012 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001013 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1014 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1015 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1016 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1017 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001018 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1019 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001020
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001021tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1022 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1023 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1024 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1025 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1026 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1027 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1028
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001029tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1030 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001031 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001032 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1033 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1034 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1035 being used for too long.
1036
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001037tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1038 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1039 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1040 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1041 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1042 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1043 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1044 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1045 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1046 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1047 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001048 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1049 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001050
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001051tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1052 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1053 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1054 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1055 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1056 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1057 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1058 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1059 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1060
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001061tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1062 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001063 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001064 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1065 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1066 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1067
1068tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1069 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1070 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1071 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1072 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010743.3. Debugging
1075--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
1077debug
1078 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1079 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1080 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1081 system startup.
1082
1083quiet
1084 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1085 line argument "-q".
1086
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010883.4. Userlists
1089--------------
1090It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1091http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1092it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1093
1094userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001095 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001096 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1097
1098group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001099 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001100 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1101 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1102
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001103user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1104 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001105 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1106 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001107 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1108 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001109 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001110 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001111
1112
1113 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001114 userlist L1
1115 group G1 users tiger,scott
1116 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001117
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001118 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1119 user scott insecure-password elgato
1120 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001121
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001122 userlist L2
1123 group G1
1124 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001125
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001126 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1127 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1128 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001129
1130 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001131
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001132
11333.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001134----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001135It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1136haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1137pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1138identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1139or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1140Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1141known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1142the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1143process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1144during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1145tables.
1146
1147peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001148 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001149 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1150
1151peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1152 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1153 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1154 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1155 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1156 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1157 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1158
1159 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1160 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1161
1162 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1163 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1164 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1165 across all peers.
1166
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001167 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1168 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1169 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1170
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001171 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001172 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001173 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1174 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1175 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001176
1177 backend mybackend
1178 mode tcp
1179 balance roundrobin
1180 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1181 stick on src
1182
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001183 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1184 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001185
1186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011874. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001188----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001189
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001190Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1191 - defaults <name>
1192 - frontend <name>
1193 - backend <name>
1194 - listen <name>
1195
1196A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1197its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1198section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001199section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001200
1201A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1202connections.
1203
1204A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1205to forward incoming connections.
1206
1207A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1208parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1209
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001210All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1211'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1212case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1213
1214Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1215logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1216proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1217However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1218name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1219
1220Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1221and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001222bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001223protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1224modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1225arbitrary criteria.
1226
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001227In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1228a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1229the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1230
1231 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1232 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1233 between responses and new requests.
1234
1235 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1236 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1237 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1238 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1239
1240 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1241 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1242 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1243
1244 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1245 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1246 client-facing connection remains open.
1247
1248 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1249 after the end of the response.
1250
1251The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1252frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1253following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1254weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1255
1256 Backend mode
1257
1258 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1259 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1260 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1261 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1262 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1263 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1264 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1265 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1266 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1267 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1268 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001270
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012724.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1273--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001275The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1276limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1277they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1278limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001279marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001280option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001281and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1282with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1283specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001284
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001285
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001286 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1287------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1288acl - X X X
1289appsession - - X X
1290backlog X X X -
1291balance X - X X
1292bind - X X -
1293bind-process X X X X
1294block - X X X
1295capture cookie - X X -
1296capture request header - X X -
1297capture response header - X X -
1298clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001299compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001300contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1301cookie X - X X
1302default-server X - X X
1303default_backend X X X -
1304description - X X X
1305disabled X X X X
1306dispatch - - X X
1307enabled X X X X
1308errorfile X X X X
1309errorloc X X X X
1310errorloc302 X X X X
1311-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1312errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001313force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001314fullconn X - X X
1315grace X X X X
1316hash-type X - X X
1317http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001318http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001319http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001320http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001321http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001322http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001323id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001324ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001325log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001326log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001327max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001328maxconn X X X -
1329mode X X X X
1330monitor fail - X X -
1331monitor-net X X X -
1332monitor-uri X X X -
1333option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1334option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1335option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1336option allbackups (*) X - X X
1337option checkcache (*) X - X X
1338option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1339option contstats (*) X X X -
1340option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1341option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1342option forceclose (*) X X X X
1343-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1344option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001345option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001346option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001347option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001348option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001349option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001350option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1351option httpchk X - X X
1352option httpclose (*) X X X X
1353option httplog X X X X
1354option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001355option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001356option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001357option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1358option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1359option logasap (*) X X X -
1360option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001361option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001362option nolinger (*) X X X X
1363option originalto X X X X
1364option persist (*) X - X X
1365option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001366option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001367option smtpchk X - X X
1368option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1369option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1370option splice-request (*) X X X X
1371option splice-response (*) X X X X
1372option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1373option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1374-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001375option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001376option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1377option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1378option tcpka X X X X
1379option tcplog X X X X
1380option transparent (*) X - X X
1381persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1382rate-limit sessions X X X -
1383redirect - X X X
1384redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1385redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1386reqadd - X X X
1387reqallow - X X X
1388reqdel - X X X
1389reqdeny - X X X
1390reqiallow - X X X
1391reqidel - X X X
1392reqideny - X X X
1393reqipass - X X X
1394reqirep - X X X
1395reqisetbe - X X X
1396reqitarpit - X X X
1397reqpass - X X X
1398reqrep - X X X
1399-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1400reqsetbe - X X X
1401reqtarpit - X X X
1402retries X - X X
1403rspadd - X X X
1404rspdel - X X X
1405rspdeny - X X X
1406rspidel - X X X
1407rspideny - X X X
1408rspirep - X X X
1409rsprep - X X X
1410server - - X X
1411source X - X X
1412srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001413stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001414stats auth X - X X
1415stats enable X - X X
1416stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001417stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001418stats realm X - X X
1419stats refresh X - X X
1420stats scope X - X X
1421stats show-desc X - X X
1422stats show-legends X - X X
1423stats show-node X - X X
1424stats uri X - X X
1425-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1426stick match - - X X
1427stick on - - X X
1428stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001429stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001430stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001431tcp-check connect - - X X
1432tcp-check expect - - X X
1433tcp-check send - - X X
1434tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001435tcp-request connection - X X -
1436tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001437tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001438tcp-response content - - X X
1439tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001440timeout check X - X X
1441timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001442timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001443timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1444timeout connect X - X X
1445timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1446timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1447timeout http-request X X X X
1448timeout queue X - X X
1449timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001450timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001451timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1452timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001453timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001454transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001455unique-id-format X X X -
1456unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001457use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001458use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001459------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1460 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014634.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1464---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001465
1466This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1467
1468
1469acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1470 Declare or complete an access list.
1471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1472 no | yes | yes | yes
1473 Example:
1474 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1475 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1476 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001478 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001479
1480
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001481appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1482 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001483 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1485 no | no | yes | yes
1486 Arguments :
1487 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1488 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1489
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001490 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001491 checked in each cookie value.
1492
1493 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1494 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1495 milliseconds.
1496
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001497 request-learn
1498 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1499 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1500 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1501 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1502 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1503 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1504
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001505 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1506 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1507 data following this prefix.
1508
1509 Example :
1510 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1511
1512 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1513 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1514
1515 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1516 2 modes are currently supported :
1517 - path-parameters :
1518 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1519 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1520 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1521 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1522 - query-string :
1523 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1524 query string.
1525
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001526 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1527 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1528 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1529 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001530 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1531 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1532 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001533 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1534 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1535
1536 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1537
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001538 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1539 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1540 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1541
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001542 Example :
1543 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1544
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001545 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1546 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001547
1548
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001549backlog <conns>
1550 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1552 yes | yes | yes | no
1553 Arguments :
1554 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1555 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001556 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001557
1558 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1559 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1560 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1561 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1562 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1563 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1564 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1565 backlog parameter.
1566
1567 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1568 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1569 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1570
1571 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1572
1573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001574balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001575balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001576 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1578 yes | no | yes | yes
1579 Arguments :
1580 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1581 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1582 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1583 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1584
1585 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1586 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1587 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1588 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001589 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001590 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001591 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1592 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1593 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1594 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1595 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1596 it, so that you don't worry.
1597
1598 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1599 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1600 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1601 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1602 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1603 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1604 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1605 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001607 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1608 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1609 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1610 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1611 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1612 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1613 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1614 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1615
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001616 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001617 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001618 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1619 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001620 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001621 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1622 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1623 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1624 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1625 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001626 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1627 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1628 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1629 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1630 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1631 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001632
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001633 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1634 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1635 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1636 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1637 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1638 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1639 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1640 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001641 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001642 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001643 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1644 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1645 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001646
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001647 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1648 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1649 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1650 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1651 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1652 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1653 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1654 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1655 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1656 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1657 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1658 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001659
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001660 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001661 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1662 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1663 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1664 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1665 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1666 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1667 URIs start with a leading "/".
1668
1669 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1670 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1671 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1672 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1673
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001674 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001675 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1676
1677 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001678 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1679 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001680 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1681 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1682 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1683 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001684 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001685 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1686 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001687
1688 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1689 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1690 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1691 server will receive the request.
1692
1693 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1694 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1695 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1696 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1697 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001698 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1699 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1700 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001701
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001702 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1703 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1704 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1705 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1706 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001708 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001709 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1710 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1711 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1712
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001713 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1714 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1715 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1716
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001717 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001718 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001719 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1720 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1721 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1722 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1723 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1724 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001725 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001726 used instead.
1727
1728 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1729 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1730 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1731 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1732
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001733 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1734 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1735 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1736
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001737 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001738
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001739 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001740 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1741 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001742
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001743 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1744 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1745 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001746
1747 Examples :
1748 balance roundrobin
1749 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001750 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001751 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1752 balance hdr(host)
1753 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001754
1755 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1756 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1757
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001758 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001759 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1760 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1761 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1762 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1763
1764 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1765 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1766 defaults to 16 kB.
1767
1768 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1769 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1770
1771 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1772 Round Robin.
1773
1774 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1775 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1776 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1777 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1778
1779 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1780
1781 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001782 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001783 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1784 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1785 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001787 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1788 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001789
1790
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001791bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1792bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001793 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1795 no | yes | yes | no
1796 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001797 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1798 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1799 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1800 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001801 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001802 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1803 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1804 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1805 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1806 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1807 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1808 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaub4fca5d2014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001809 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1810 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1811 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1812 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1813 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1814 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1815 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001816 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1817 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1818 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001819 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1820 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1821 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1822 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001823
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001824 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1825 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001826 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1827 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1828 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001829 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1830 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1831 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1832 the range.
1833
1834 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1835 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1836 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1837 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1838 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1839 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1840 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001841 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001842 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001843
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001844 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1845 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1846 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1847 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1848 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1849 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1850 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1851 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1852
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001853 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1854 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1855 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1856 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001857
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001858 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1859 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1860 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1861 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1862 in a frontend.
1863
1864 Example :
1865 listen http_proxy
1866 bind :80,:443
1867 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001868 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001870 listen http_https_proxy
1871 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001872 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001873
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001874 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1875 bind ipv6@:80
1876 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1877 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1878
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001879 listen external_bind_app1
1880 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1881
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001882 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001883 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001884
1885
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001886bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001887 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1889 yes | yes | yes | yes
1890 Arguments :
1891 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1892 may be used to override a default value.
1893
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001894 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001895 option may be combined with other numbers.
1896
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001897 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001898 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1899 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1900 missing from all processes.
1901
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001902 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001903 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001904 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1905 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1906 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1907 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001908
1909 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1910 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1911 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1912 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1913 and 'even' instances.
1914
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001915 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1916 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1917 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1918 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001919
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001920 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1921 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1922
Willy Tarreaue56c4f12014-09-16 13:21:03 +02001923 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
1924 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
1925 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
1926
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001927 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1928 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1929
1930 Example :
1931 listen app_ip1
1932 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001933 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001934
1935 listen app_ip2
1936 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001937 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001938
1939 listen management
1940 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001941 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001942
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001943 listen management
1944 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1945 bind-process 1-4
1946
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001947 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001948
1949
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001950block { if | unless } <condition>
1951 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1953 no | yes | yes | yes
1954
1955 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1956 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001957 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001958 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001959 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1960 "block" statements per instance.
1961
1962 Example:
1963 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1964 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1965 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1966 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001968 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001969
1970
1971capture cookie <name> len <length>
1972 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1974 no | yes | yes | no
1975 Arguments :
1976 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1977 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1978 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1979 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1980 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1981
1982 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1983 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1984 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1985 right if it exceeds <length>.
1986
1987 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1988 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1989 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1990 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1991
1992 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1993 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1994 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1995
1996 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1997 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1998 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001999 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2000 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2001 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002002
2003 Example:
2004 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2005
2006 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002007 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002008
2009
2010capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002011 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2013 no | yes | yes | no
2014 Arguments :
2015 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002016 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2018 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2019 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2020
2021 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2022 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2023 it exceeds <length>.
2024
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002025 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002026 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2027 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002028 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2029 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2030 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2031 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002032 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002033 environments to find where the request came from.
2034
2035 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2036 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2037 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2038 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002039
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002040 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2041 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2042 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2043 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2044 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002045
2046 Example:
2047 capture request header Host len 15
2048 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2049 capture request header Referrer len 15
2050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002051 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002052 about logging.
2053
2054
2055capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002056 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2058 no | yes | yes | no
2059 Arguments :
2060 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002061 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002062 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2063 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2064 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2065
2066 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2067 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2068 it exceeds <length>.
2069
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002070 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002071 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2072 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2073 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002074 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2075 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2076 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2077 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002078
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002079 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2080 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2081 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2082 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2083 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084
2085 Example:
2086 capture response header Content-length len 9
2087 capture response header Location len 15
2088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002089 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002090 about logging.
2091
2092
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002093clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002094 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2096 yes | yes | yes | no
2097 Arguments :
2098 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2099 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2100 as explained at the top of this document.
2101
2102 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2103 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2104 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2105 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2106 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2107 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2108 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2109 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002110 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002111 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2112 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2113
2114 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2115 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2116 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2117 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2118 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2119 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2120
2121 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2122 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2123
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002124 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2125 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002126
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002127compression algo <algorithm> ...
2128compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002129compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002130 Enable HTTP compression.
2131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2132 yes | yes | yes | yes
2133 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002134 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2135 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2136 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2137
2138 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002139 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002140 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2141 data.
2142
2143 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2144 support for zlib was built in.
2145
2146 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2147 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2148 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2149 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2150 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2151 in.
2152
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002153 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002154 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002155 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2156 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2157 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2158 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2159 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002160
2161 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2162 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2163 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2164 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2165 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002166 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2167 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2168 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2169 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2170 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreau4cf57af2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002171 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2172 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002173
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002174 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002175 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2176 "Accept-Encoding" header
2177 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002178 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002179 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2180 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002181 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2182 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2183 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2184 "multipart"
2185 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2186 header
2187 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2188 and later
2189 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2190 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002191
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002192 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2193 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002194
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002195 Examples :
2196 compression algo gzip
2197 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002199contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002200 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2202 yes | no | yes | yes
2203 Arguments :
2204 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2205 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2206 as explained at the top of this document.
2207
2208 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002209 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002210 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002211 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2212 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2213 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2214 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2215
2216 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2217 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2218 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2219 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2220 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2221 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2222
2223 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2224 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2225 instead.
2226
2227 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2228 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2229
2230
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002231cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002232 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2233 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002234 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2236 yes | no | yes | yes
2237 Arguments :
2238 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2239 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2240 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2241 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2242 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2243 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2244 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2245 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2246 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2247
2248 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2249 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2250 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2251 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2252 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2253 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2254 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2255 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2256 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2257 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2258 "insert" and "prefix".
2259
2260 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002261 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002262
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002263 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002264 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2265 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2266 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2267 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2268 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2269 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2270 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2271 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2272 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2273 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274
2275 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2276 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2277 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2278 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2279 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2280 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2281 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2282 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2283 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2284 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002285 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2286 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2287 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002288
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002289 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2290 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2291 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002292 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2293 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2294 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2295 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002296 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2297 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2298 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002299
2300 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2301 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2302 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2303 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2304 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2305 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2306 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2307 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2308 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2309
2310 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2311 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2312 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2313 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2314 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2315 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2316 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2317 persistence cookie in the cache.
2318 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2319
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002320 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2321 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2322 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2323 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2324 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2325 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2326 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2327 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2328 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2329 they logout.
2330
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002331 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2332 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2333 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2334 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2335
2336 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2337 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2338 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2339 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2340 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2341 this attribute.
2342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002343 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002344 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002345 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2346 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2347 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2348 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2349 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2350 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002351
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002352 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2353 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2354 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2355 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2356 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2357 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2358 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2359 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2360 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2361 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2362 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2363 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2364 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2365 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2366 the site.
2367
2368 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2369 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2370 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2371 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2372 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2373 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2374 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2375 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2376 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2377 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2378 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2379 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2380 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2381 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2382 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2383 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2384
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002385 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2386 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2387 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2388 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002389
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390 Examples :
2391 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2392 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2393 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002394 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002395
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002396 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002397 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002398
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002399
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002400default-server [param*]
2401 Change default options for a server in a backend
2402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2403 yes | no | yes | yes
2404 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002405 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2406 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2407 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2408 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002409
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002410 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002411 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2412
2413 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002414
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002416default_backend <backend>
2417 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2419 yes | yes | yes | no
2420 Arguments :
2421 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2422
2423 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2424 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2425 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2426 will catch all undetermined requests.
2427
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428 Example :
2429
2430 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2431 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2432 default_backend dynamic
2433
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002434 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2435
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002437description <string>
2438 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2440 no | yes | yes | yes
2441 Arguments : string
2442
2443 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2444 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2445 it describes.
2446 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2447
2448
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002449disabled
2450 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2452 yes | yes | yes | yes
2453 Arguments : none
2454
2455 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2456 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2457 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2458 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2459 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2460 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2461 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2462
2463 See also : "enabled"
2464
2465
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002466dispatch <address>:<port>
2467 Set a default server address
2468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2469 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002470 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002471
2472 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2473 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2474 during start-up.
2475
2476 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2477 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2478 possible with normal servers.
2479
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002480 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002481 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2482 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2483 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2484 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2485
2486 See also : "server"
2487
2488
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002489enabled
2490 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2492 yes | yes | yes | yes
2493 Arguments : none
2494
2495 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2496 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2497
2498 See also : "disabled"
2499
2500
2501errorfile <code> <file>
2502 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2504 yes | yes | yes | yes
2505 Arguments :
2506 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002507 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002508
2509 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002510 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002511 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002512 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2513 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002514
2515 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2516 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2517 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2518
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002519 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2520
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002521 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2522 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2523 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2524 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2525
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002526 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2527 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2528 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2529 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2530 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2531 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2532
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002533 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2534 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2535 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002536 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002537 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2538
2539 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2540
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002541 Example :
2542 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002543 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002544 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2545 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2546
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002547
2548errorloc <code> <url>
2549errorloc302 <code> <url>
2550 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2552 yes | yes | yes | yes
2553 Arguments :
2554 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002555 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002556
2557 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2558 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2559 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2560 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2561 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2562
2563 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2564 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2565 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2566
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002567 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002569 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2570 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2571 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2572 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2573 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2574 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2575 request.
2576
2577 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2578
2579
2580errorloc303 <code> <url>
2581 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2583 yes | yes | yes | yes
2584 Arguments :
2585 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2586 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2587
2588 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2589 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2590 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2591 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2592 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2593
2594 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2595 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2596 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2597
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002598 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2599
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002600 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2601 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2602 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2603 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002604 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002605
2606 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2607
2608
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002609force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2610 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2612 no | yes | yes | yes
2613
2614 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2615 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2616 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2617 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2618 marked down for maintenance operations.
2619
2620 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2621 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2622 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2623 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2624 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2625 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2626 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2627 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2628 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2629
2630 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2631 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2632 is used.
2633
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002634 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002635 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002636
2637
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002638fullconn <conns>
2639 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2641 yes | no | yes | yes
2642 Arguments :
2643 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2644 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2645
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002646 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002647 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002648 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002649 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2650 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2651 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2652 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2653 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002654 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002655
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002656 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2657 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002658 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2659 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2660 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002661
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002662 Example :
2663 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2664 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2665 # connections.
2666 backend dynamic
2667 fullconn 10000
2668 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2669 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2670
2671 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2672
2673
2674grace <time>
2675 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002677 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002678 Arguments :
2679 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2680 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2681 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2682
2683 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2684 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002685 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002686 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2687
2688 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2689 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2690 simplify it.
2691
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002692
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002693hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002694 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2696 yes | no | yes | yes
2697 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002698 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2699 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002700
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002701 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2702 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2703 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2704 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2705 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2706 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2707 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2708 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2709 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2710 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002711
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002712 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2713 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2714 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2715 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2716 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2717 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2718 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2719 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2720 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2721 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2722 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2723 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2724 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002725 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2726 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002727
2728 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2729
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002730 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002731 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2732 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2733 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002734 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2735 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2736 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002737
2738 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2739 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002740 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2741 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2742 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2743 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2744
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002745 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2746 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2747 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2748 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2749 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2750 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2751 parameter.
2752
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002753 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2754
2755 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2756 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2757 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2758 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2759 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2760 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2761 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2762 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2763 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2764 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2765 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2766 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002767
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002768 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2769 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2770 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002771
2772 See also : "balance", "server"
2773
2774
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002775http-check disable-on-404
2776 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002778 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002779 Arguments : none
2780
2781 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2782 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2783 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2784 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2785 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2786 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2787 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2788 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002789 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2790 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2791 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2792
2793 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2794
2795
2796http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002797 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002799 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002800 Arguments :
2801 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2802 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002803 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002804 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2805 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2806 details on the supported keywords.
2807
2808 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2809 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2810 with the usual backslash ('\').
2811
2812 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2813 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2814 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2815 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2816 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2817
2818 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002819 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002820 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2821 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2822 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2823
2824 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002825 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002826 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2827 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2828 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2829 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2830
2831 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002832 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002833 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2834 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2835 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2836 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2837 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2838 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2839 trace).
2840
2841 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002842 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002843 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2844 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2845 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2846 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2847 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2848 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2849
2850 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2851 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2852 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2853 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2854 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2855 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2856 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2857 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2858
Cyril Bontéa448e162015-01-30 00:07:07 +01002859 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
2860 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
2861 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
2862
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002863 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2864 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2865
2866 Examples :
2867 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002868 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002869
2870 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002871 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002872
2873 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002874 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002875
2876 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002877 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002878
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002879 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002880
2881
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002882http-check send-state
2883 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2885 yes | no | yes | yes
2886 Arguments : none
2887
2888 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2889 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2890 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2891 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2892 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2893
2894 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2895 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2896 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2897 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2898 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2899 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2900 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2901 checked in multiple backends.
2902
2903 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2904 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2905
2906 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2907 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2908 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2909 one fails.
2910
2911 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2912 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2913 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2914
2915 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2916 server's queue.
2917
2918 Example of a header received by the application server :
2919 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2920 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2921
2922 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2923
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002924http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002925 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002926 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002927 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2928 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002929 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2930 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2931 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2932 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2933 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2934 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002935 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002936 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2937
2938 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2939 no | yes | yes | yes
2940
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002941 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2942 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2943 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2944 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2945 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002946
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002947 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2948 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2949 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2950
2951 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2952 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2953 are evaluated.
2954
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002955 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2956 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2957 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2958 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2959 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2960 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2961 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2962 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2963 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002964 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002965 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2966
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002967 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2968 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2969 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2970 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2971 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2972
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002973 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2974 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2975 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002976 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2977 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002978
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002979 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2980 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2981 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2982 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2983 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2984 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2985 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2986 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2987
2988 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2989 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2990 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreaufcf75d22015-01-21 20:39:27 +01002991 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
2992 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002993
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002994 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2995 <name>.
2996
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002997 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
2998 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
2999 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3000 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3001 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3002 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3003 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3004 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3005
3006 Example:
3007
3008 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3009
3010 applied to:
3011
3012 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3013
3014 outputs:
3015
3016 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3017
3018 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3019
3020 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3021 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3022 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3023 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3024 header.
3025
3026 Example:
3027
3028 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3029
3030 applied to:
3031
3032 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3033
3034 outputs:
3035
3036 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3037
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003038 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3039 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3040 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3041 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3042 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3043 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3044 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3045 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3046
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003047 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3048 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3049 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3050 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3051 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3052 another equipment.
3053
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003054 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3055 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3056 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3057 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3058 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3059 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3060 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3061 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3062
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003063 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3064 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3065 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3066 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3067 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3068 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3069 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3070 admin privileges.
3071
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003072 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3073 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3074 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3075 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3076 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3077 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3078 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3079 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3080
3081 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3082 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3083 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3084 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3085 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3086 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3087
3088 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3089 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3090 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3091 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3092 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3093 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3094
3095 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3096 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3097 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3098 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3099 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3100 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3101 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3102 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3103 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3104
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003105 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3106
3107 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3108 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3109 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3110 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003111
3112 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003113 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3114 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3115 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003116
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003117 http-request allow if nagios
3118 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3119 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3120 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003121
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003122 Example:
3123 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003124 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003125
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003126 Example:
3127 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3128 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3129 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3130 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3131 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3132 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3133 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3134 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3135 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3136
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003137 Example:
3138 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3139 acl add path /addacl
3140 acl del path /delacl
3141
3142 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3143
3144 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3145 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3146
3147 Example:
3148 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3149 acl setmap path /setmap
3150 acl delmap path /delmap
3151
3152 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3153
3154 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3155 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3156
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003157 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3158 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003159
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003160http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003161 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003162 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3163 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003164 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3165 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3166 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3167 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3168 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3169 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003170 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003171 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3172
3173 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3174 no | yes | yes | yes
3175
3176 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3177 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3178 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3179 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3180 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3181 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3182
3183 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3184 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3185 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3186 current section.
3187
3188 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3189 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3190 rules are evaluated.
3191
3192 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3193 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3194 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3195 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3196 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3197 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3198 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3199
3200 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3201 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3202 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3203 external users.
3204
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003205 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3206 <name>.
3207
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003208 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3209 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3210 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3211 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3212 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3213 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3214 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3215 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3216
3217 Example:
3218
3219 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3220
3221 applied to:
3222
3223 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3224
3225 outputs:
3226
3227 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3228
3229 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3230
3231 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3232 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3233 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3234 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3235 header.
3236
3237 Example:
3238
3239 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3240
3241 applied to:
3242
3243 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3244
3245 outputs:
3246
3247 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3248
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003249 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3250 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3251 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3252 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3253 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3254 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3255 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3256 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3257
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003258 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3259 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3260 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3261 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3262 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3263 another equipment.
3264
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003265 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3266 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3267 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3268 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3269 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3270 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3271 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3272 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3273
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003274 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3275 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3276 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3277 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3278 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3279 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3280 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3281 admin privileges.
3282
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003283 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3284 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3285 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3286 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3287 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3288 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3289 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3290 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3291
3292 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3293 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3294 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3295 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3296 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3297 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3298
3299 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3300 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3301 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3302 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3303 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3304 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3305
3306 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3307 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3308 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3309 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3310 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3311 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3312 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3313 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3314 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3315
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003316 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3317
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003318 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003319 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3320 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3321 rules.
3322
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003323 Example:
3324 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3325
3326 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3327
3328 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3329 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3330
3331 Example:
3332 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3333
3334 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3335
3336 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3337 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3338
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003339 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3340 ACL usage.
3341
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003342
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003343http-send-name-header [<header>]
3344 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3345
3346 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3347 yes | no | yes | yes
3348
3349 Arguments :
3350
3351 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3352
3353 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3354 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3355 is added with the header string proved.
3356
3357 See also : "server"
3358
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003359id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003360 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3362 no | yes | yes | yes
3363 Arguments : none
3364
3365 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3366 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3367 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003368
3369
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003370ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3371 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3372 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3373 no | yes | yes | yes
3374
3375 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3376 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3377 and running).
3378
3379 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3380 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3381 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003382 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003383 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3384
3385 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3386 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3387
3388 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3389 "unless" condition is met.
3390
3391 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3392
3393
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003394log global
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003395log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003396no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003397 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3399 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003400
3401 Prefix :
3402 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3403 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3404 prefix does not allow arguments.
3405
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003406 Arguments :
3407 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3408 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3409 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3410 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3411 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3412 parameter.
3413
3414 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3415 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3416
3417 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3418 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3419 standard syslog port).
3420
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003421 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3422 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3423 standard syslog port).
3424
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003425 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3426 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3427 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3428 appropriately writeable).
3429
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003430 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3431 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3432 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3433 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3434
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003435 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3436 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3437 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3438 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3439 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3440 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3441 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3442 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3443 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3444 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3445 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3446
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003447 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3448
3449 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3450 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3451 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3452
3453 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3454 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3455 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003456 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3457 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3458 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3459 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3460 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003461
3462 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3463
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003464 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3465 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3466 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003467
3468 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3469 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3470 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3471 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3472
3473 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3474 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003475
3476 Example :
3477 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003478 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3479 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003480 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3481
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003482
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003483log-format <string>
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003484 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3485 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3486 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003487
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003488 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3489 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3490 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3491 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3492 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003493
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003494
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003495max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3496 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3497 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3498 yes | no | yes | yes
3499
3500 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3501 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3502 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3503 servers.
3504
3505 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3506 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3507 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3508 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3509 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3510 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3511 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3512 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3513 picking a different server.
3514
3515 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3516 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3517 even if they have to be queued.
3518
3519 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3520 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3521
3522
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003523maxconn <conns>
3524 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3526 yes | yes | yes | no
3527 Arguments :
3528 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3529 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3530 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3531 closes.
3532
3533 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3534 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3535 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3536 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3537 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3538 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3539 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3540 properly tuned.
3541
3542 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3543 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3544 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3545
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003546 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3547
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003548 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3549
3550
3551mode { tcp|http|health }
3552 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3554 yes | yes | yes | yes
3555 Arguments :
3556 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3557 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3558 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3559 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3560
3561 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3562 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3563 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3564 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3565 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3566
3567 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003568 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3569 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3570 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3571 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3572 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3573 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3574 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003575
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003576 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3577 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3578 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003579
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003580 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003581 defaults http_instances
3582 mode http
3583
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003584 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003585
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003586
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003587monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003588 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3590 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003591 Arguments :
3592 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3593 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003594 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003595 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3596 backend and its backup.
3597
3598 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3599 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3600 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3601 servers in a list of backends.
3602
3603 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3604 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3605 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3606 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3607 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3608 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3609 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003610 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3611 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003612
3613 Example:
3614 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003615 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003616 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3617 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3618 monitor-uri /site_alive
3619 monitor fail if site_dead
3620
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003621 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003622
3623
3624monitor-net <source>
3625 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3627 yes | yes | yes | no
3628 Arguments :
3629 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3630 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3631 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3632 followed by a mask.
3633
3634 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3635 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003636 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003637 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3638
3639 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3640 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3641 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3642 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003643 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3644 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3645 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003646
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003647 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3648 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3649 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3650 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3651 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3652 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003653
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003654 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3655 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003656
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003657 Example :
3658 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3659 frontend www
3660 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3661
3662 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3663
3664
3665monitor-uri <uri>
3666 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3668 yes | yes | yes | no
3669 Arguments :
3670 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3671 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3672
3673 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3674 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3675 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3676 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3677 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3678 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3679 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3680 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3681
3682 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3683 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3684 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3685 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3686 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3687 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3688
3689 Example :
3690 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3691 frontend www
3692 mode http
3693 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3694
3695 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3696
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003697
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003698option abortonclose
3699no option abortonclose
3700 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3702 yes | no | yes | yes
3703 Arguments : none
3704
3705 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3706 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3707 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3708 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003709 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003710 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3711 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3712 encountered while delivering the response.
3713
3714 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3715 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3716 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3717 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3718 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3719 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003720 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003721 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003722 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003723 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3724 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3725 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3726
3727 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3728 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3729 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3730 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3731 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3732 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3733 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3734 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003735 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003736
3737 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3738 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3739
3740 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3741
3742
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003743option accept-invalid-http-request
3744no option accept-invalid-http-request
3745 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3747 yes | yes | yes | no
3748 Arguments : none
3749
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003750 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003751 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3752 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3753 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3754 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3755 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3756 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3757 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003758 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3759 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3760 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3761 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3762 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003763 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
3764 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple
3765 digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003766
3767 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3768 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3769 been confirmed.
3770
3771 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3772 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003773 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3774 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003775 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3776
3777 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3778 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3779
3780 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3781 stats socket.
3782
3783
3784option accept-invalid-http-response
3785no option accept-invalid-http-response
3786 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3788 yes | no | yes | yes
3789 Arguments : none
3790
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003791 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003792 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3793 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3794 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3795 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3796 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3797 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3798 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003799 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
3800 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
3801 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003802
3803 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3804 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3805 been confirmed.
3806
3807 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3808 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3809 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3810 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3811
3812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3814
3815 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3816 stats socket.
3817
3818
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003819option allbackups
3820no option allbackups
3821 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3823 yes | no | yes | yes
3824 Arguments : none
3825
3826 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3827 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3828 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3829 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3830 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3831 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3832 order between the backup servers anymore.
3833
3834 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3835 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3836
3837 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3838 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3839
3840
3841option checkcache
3842no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003843 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3845 yes | no | yes | yes
3846 Arguments : none
3847
3848 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3849 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003850 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003851 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3852 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003853 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003854
3855 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003856 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003857 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003858 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3859 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003860 to the client are :
3861 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003862 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003863 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003864 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3865 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3866 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3867 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3868 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3869 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3870 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3871 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3872 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3873 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3874 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3875
3876 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003877 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003878 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003879 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003880 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3881
3882 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3883 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003884 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003885 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3886
3887 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3888 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3889
3890
3891option clitcpka
3892no option clitcpka
3893 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3895 yes | yes | yes | no
3896 Arguments : none
3897
3898 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3899 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3900 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3901 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3902
3903 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3904 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3905 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3906 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3907
3908 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3909 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3910 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3911 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3912 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3913
3914 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3915
3916 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3917 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3918 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3919
3920 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3921 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3922
3923 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3924
3925
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003926option contstats
3927 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3929 yes | yes | yes | no
3930 Arguments : none
3931
3932 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3933 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3934 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3935 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3936 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3937 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3938 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3939
3940
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003941option dontlog-normal
3942no option dontlog-normal
3943 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3945 yes | yes | yes | no
3946 Arguments : none
3947
3948 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3949 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3950 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3951 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3952 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3953 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3954 logged.
3955
3956 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3957 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3958 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003960 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003961 logging.
3962
3963
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003964option dontlognull
3965no option dontlognull
3966 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3968 yes | yes | yes | no
3969 Arguments : none
3970
3971 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3972 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3973 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3974 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3975 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3976 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3977 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3978
3979 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3980 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3981 would not be logged.
3982
3983 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3984 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3985
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003986 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003987
3988
3989option forceclose
3990no option forceclose
3991 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003993 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003994 Arguments : none
3995
3996 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3997 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3998 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3999 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4000 global session times in the logs.
4001
4002 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004003 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004004 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004005
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004006 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4007 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4008 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4009
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004010 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4011 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004012
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004013 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4014 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4015
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004016 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004017
4018
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004019option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004020 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4022 yes | yes | yes | yes
4023 Arguments :
4024 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4025 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004026 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004027 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004028
4029 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4030 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4031 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4032 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4033 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4034 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4035 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004036 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4037 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4038 possible that the client has already brought one.
4039
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004040 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004041 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004042 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4043 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004044 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4045 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004046
4047 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4048 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4049 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4050 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4051 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4052 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4053 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4054
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004055 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4056 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4057 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4058 are under the control of the end-user.
4059
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004060 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004061 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4062 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004063 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4064 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4065 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004066
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004067 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004068 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4069 frontend www
4070 mode http
4071 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4072
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004073 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4074 backend www
4075 mode http
4076 option forwardfor header X-Client
4077
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004078 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004079 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004080
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004081
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004082option http-keep-alive
4083no option http-keep-alive
4084 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4086 yes | yes | yes | yes
4087 Arguments : none
4088
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004089 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4090 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4091 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4092 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4093 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4094 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4095 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4096
4097 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4098 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004099 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4100 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4101 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4102 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4103 situations where this option may be useful :
4104
4105 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4106 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4107
4108 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4109 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4110
4111 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4112 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4113 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4114 request.
4115
4116 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4117 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004118 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4119 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4120 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004121
4122 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4123 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4124
4125 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4126 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4127 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4128 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4129 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4130 not set.
4131
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004132 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4133 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004134 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004135 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004136
4137 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004138 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4139 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004140
4141
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004142option http-no-delay
4143no option http-no-delay
4144 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4146 yes | yes | yes | yes
4147 Arguments : none
4148
4149 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4150 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4151 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4152 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4153 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4154 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4155 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4156 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4157 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4158 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4159 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4160 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4161 affected.
4162
4163 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4164 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4165 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4166 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4167 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4168 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4169 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4170 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4171 latency environments.
4172
4173
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004174option http-pretend-keepalive
4175no option http-pretend-keepalive
4176 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4178 yes | yes | yes | yes
4179 Arguments : none
4180
4181 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4182 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4183 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4184 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4185 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4186 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4187 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4188 consider the response complete.
4189
4190 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4191 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4192 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4193 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4194 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4195 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4196
4197 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4198 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4199 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4200 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4201 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4202 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4203 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4204
4205 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4206 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004207 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004208 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4209 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004210
4211 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4212 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4213
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004214 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4215 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004216
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004217
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004218option http-server-close
4219no option http-server-close
4220 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4222 yes | yes | yes | yes
4223 Arguments : none
4224
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004225 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4226 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4227 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4228 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4229 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4230 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4231 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4232 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4233 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4234 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4235 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4236 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4237 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4238 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4239 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4240 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004241
4242 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4243 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4244 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4245 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004246 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4247 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004248
4249 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4250 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004251 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4252 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004253 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4254 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004255
4256 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4257 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4258
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004259 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004260 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4261 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004262
4263
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004264option http-tunnel
4265no option http-tunnel
4266 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4268 yes | yes | yes | yes
4269 Arguments : none
4270
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004271 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4272 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4273 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4274 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4275 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4276 "option http-tunnel".
4277
4278 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004279 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004280 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4281 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4282 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4283 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4284 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4285 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4286 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004287
4288 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4289 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4290
4291 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4292 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4293 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4294
4295
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004296option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004297no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004298 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4300 yes | yes | yes | no
4301 Arguments : none
4302
4303 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4304 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4305 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4306 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4307 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4308 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4309 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4310
4311 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4312 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4313 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4314 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4315 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4316 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4317 request along its whole life.
4318
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004319 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4320 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4321 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4322 front of an existing proxy.
4323
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004324 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4325
4326 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4327 http-server-close".
4328
4329
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004330option httpchk
4331option httpchk <uri>
4332option httpchk <method> <uri>
4333option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4334 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4336 yes | no | yes | yes
4337 Arguments :
4338 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4339 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4340 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4341 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4342 ones.
4343
4344 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4345 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4346 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4347
4348 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4349 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4350 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4351 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4352 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4353
4354 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4355 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4356 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4357 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4358 the lack of any response.
4359
4360 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4361
4362 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4363 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4364 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4365
4366 Examples :
4367 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4368 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4369 backend https_relay
4370 mode tcp
4371 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4372 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4373
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004374 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4375 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4376 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004377
4378
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004379option httpclose
4380no option httpclose
4381 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4383 yes | yes | yes | yes
4384 Arguments : none
4385
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004386 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4387 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4388 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4389 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004390 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004391 "option http-tunnel".
4392
4393 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4394 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4395 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4396 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4397 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4398 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4399 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4400 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004401
4402 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004403 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004404 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4405 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4406 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4407 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4408 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004409
4410 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4411 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004412 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4413 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004414 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4415 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004416
4417 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4418 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4419
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004420 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4421 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004422
4423
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004424option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004425 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4427 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004428 Arguments :
4429 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4430 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4431 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4432 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4433 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004434
4435 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4436 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4437 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4438 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4439 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4440 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4441 ports.
4442
4443 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4444
PiBa-NL211c2e92014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004445 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4446 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004448 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004449
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004450
4451option http_proxy
4452no option http_proxy
4453 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4455 yes | yes | yes | yes
4456 Arguments : none
4457
4458 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4459 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4460 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4461 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4462 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4463
4464 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4465 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4466 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4467 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004468 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004469 be analyzed.
4470
4471 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4472 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4473
4474 Example :
4475 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4476 backend direct_forward
4477 option httpclose
4478 option http_proxy
4479
4480 See also : "option httpclose"
4481
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004482
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004483option independent-streams
4484no option independent-streams
4485 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4487 yes | yes | yes | yes
4488 Arguments : none
4489
4490 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4491 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4492 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4493 receive data or not.
4494
4495 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4496 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4497 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4498 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4499 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4500 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4501 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4502 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4503 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4504 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4505 socket buffers.
4506
4507 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4508 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4509 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4510 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4511 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4512
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004513 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004514 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4515 deprecated.
4516
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004517 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004518
4519
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004520option ldap-check
4521 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4523 yes | no | yes | yes
4524 Arguments : none
4525
4526 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4527 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4528 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4529 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4530
4531 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4532 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4533
4534 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4535 configure it.
4536
4537 Example :
4538 option ldap-check
4539
4540 See also : "option httpchk"
4541
4542
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004543option log-health-checks
4544no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004545 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4547 yes | no | yes | yes
4548 Arguments : none
4549
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004550 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4551 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4552 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004553
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004554 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4555 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4556 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4557 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4558 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4559
4560 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4561 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004562
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004563 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4564 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4565 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004566
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004567
4568option log-separate-errors
4569no option log-separate-errors
4570 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4572 yes | yes | yes | no
4573 Arguments : none
4574
4575 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4576 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4577 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4578 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4579 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4580 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4581 provides very important information.
4582
4583 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4584 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4585 error logs.
4586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004587 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004588 logging.
4589
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004590
4591option logasap
4592no option logasap
4593 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4595 yes | yes | yes | no
4596 Arguments : none
4597
4598 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4599 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4600 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4601 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4602 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4603 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4604 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004605 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004606 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4607 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4608
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004609 Examples :
4610 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4611 mode http
4612 option httplog
4613 option logasap
4614 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4615
4616 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4617 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4618 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4619 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4620
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004621 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004622 logging.
4623
4624
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004625option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004626 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4628 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004629 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004630 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4631 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004632 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004633
4634 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4635 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4636 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4637 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4638 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4639 in the MySQL table, like this :
4640
4641 USE mysql;
4642 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4643 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4644
4645 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4646 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4647 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4648 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4649 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4650 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4651 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4652 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4653 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4654
4655 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4656 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004657
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004658 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004659
4660 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4661 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4662 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4663 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4664 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4665 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4666
4667 See also: "option httpchk"
4668
4669
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004670option nolinger
4671no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004672 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004673 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4674 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004675 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004676
4677 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4678 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4679 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4680 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4681 connections.
4682
4683 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4684 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4685 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4686 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4687 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4688 this too.
4689
4690 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4691 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4692 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4693
4694 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4695 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4696 for servers.
4697
4698 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4699 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4700
4701
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004702option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4703 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4705 yes | yes | yes | yes
4706 Arguments :
4707 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4708 matching <network>
4709 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4710 header name.
4711
4712 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4713 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4714 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4715 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4716 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4717 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4718 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4719 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4720 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4721 possible that the client has already brought one.
4722
4723 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4724 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4725 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4726 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4727 header and requires different one.
4728
4729 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4730 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4731 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4732 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4733 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4734 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4735 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4736
4737 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4738 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4739 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4740 both are defined.
4741
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004742 Examples :
4743 # Original Destination address
4744 frontend www
4745 mode http
4746 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4747
4748 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4749 backend www
4750 mode http
4751 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4752
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004753 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4754 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004755
4756
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004757option persist
4758no option persist
4759 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4760 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4761 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004762 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004763
4764 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4765 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4766 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4767 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4768 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4769 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4770 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4771 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4772 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4773 redirected to another valid server.
4774
4775 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4776 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4777
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004778 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004779
4780
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004781option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4782 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4784 yes | no | yes | yes
4785 Arguments :
4786 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4787 PostgreSQL server.
4788
4789 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4790 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4791 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4792 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4793
4794 See also: "option httpchk"
4795
4796
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004797option prefer-last-server
4798no option prefer-last-server
4799 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4800 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4801 yes | no | yes | yes
4802 Arguments : none
4803
4804 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4805 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4806 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4807 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4808 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4809 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4810 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4811 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4812 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004813 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4814 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4815 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4816 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4817 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4818 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4819 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004820
4821 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4822 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4823
4824 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4825
4826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004827option redispatch
4828no option redispatch
4829 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4830 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4831 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004832 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004833
4834 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4835 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4836 be able to access the service anymore.
4837
4838 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4839 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4840
4841 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4842 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4843 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004844
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004845 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4846 "redisp" keywords.
4847
4848 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4849 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4850
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004851 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004852
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004853
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004854option redis-check
4855 Use redis health checks for server testing
4856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4857 yes | no | yes | yes
4858 Arguments : none
4859
4860 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4861 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4862 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4863 find the "+PONG" response message.
4864
4865 Example :
4866 option redis-check
4867
4868 See also : "option httpchk"
4869
4870
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004871option smtpchk
4872option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4873 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4875 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004876 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004877 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4878 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4879 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4880
4881 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4882 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4883 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4884
4885 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4886 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4887 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4888 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4889 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4890 dead server.
4891
4892 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4893 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4894 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4895 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4896
4897 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4898 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4899 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4900 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4901 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4902
4903 Example :
4904 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4905
4906 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4907
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004908
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004909option socket-stats
4910no option socket-stats
4911
4912 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4914 yes | yes | yes | no
4915
4916 Arguments : none
4917
4918
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004919option splice-auto
4920no option splice-auto
4921 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4923 yes | yes | yes | yes
4924 Arguments : none
4925
4926 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4927 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4928 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4929 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004930 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004931 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4932 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4933 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4934 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4935
4936 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4937 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4938 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4939 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4940 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4941 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4942 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4943 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4944 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4945 keyword.
4946
4947 Example :
4948 option splice-auto
4949
4950 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4951 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4952
4953 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4954 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4955
4956
4957option splice-request
4958no option splice-request
4959 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4961 yes | yes | yes | yes
4962 Arguments : none
4963
4964 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004965 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004966 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4967 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4968 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4969 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4970
4971 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4972
4973 Example :
4974 option splice-request
4975
4976 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4977 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4978
4979 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4980 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4981
4982
4983option splice-response
4984no option splice-response
4985 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4987 yes | yes | yes | yes
4988 Arguments : none
4989
4990 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004991 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004992 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4993 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4994 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4995 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4996
4997 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4998
4999 Example :
5000 option splice-response
5001
5002 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5003 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5004
5005 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5006 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5007
5008
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005009option srvtcpka
5010no option srvtcpka
5011 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5013 yes | no | yes | yes
5014 Arguments : none
5015
5016 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5017 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5018 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5019 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5020
5021 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5022 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5023 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5024 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5025
5026 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5027 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5028 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5029 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5030 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5031
5032 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5033
5034 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5035 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5036 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5037
5038 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5039 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5040
5041 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5042
5043
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005044option ssl-hello-chk
5045 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5047 yes | no | yes | yes
5048 Arguments : none
5049
5050 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5051 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5052 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5053 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5054 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5055 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5056 hello message.
5057
5058 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5059 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5060 messages, which is appreciable.
5061
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005062 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5063 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5064 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005065
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005066 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5067
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005068
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005069option tcp-check
5070 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5071 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5072 yes | no | yes | yes
5073
5074 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5075 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5076
5077 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5078 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5079 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5080
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005081 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005082 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5083 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5084 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5085 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5086 only.
5087
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005088 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005089 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5090 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5091 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5092 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5093
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005094 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005095 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5096 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005097 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005098 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5099 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5100 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5101 the respective protocols.
5102 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5103 analysed.
5104
5105 Examples :
5106 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5107 option tcp-check
5108 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5109
5110 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5111 option tcp-check
5112 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5113
5114 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5115 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005116 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005117 option tcp-check
5118 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5119 tcp-check expect +PONG
5120 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5121 tcp-check expect string role:master
5122 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5123 tcp-check expect string +OK
5124
5125 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5126 (send many headers before analyzing)
5127 option tcp-check
5128 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5129 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5130 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5131 tcp-check send \r\n
5132 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5133
5134
5135 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5136
5137
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005138option tcp-smart-accept
5139no option tcp-smart-accept
5140 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5142 yes | yes | yes | no
5143 Arguments : none
5144
5145 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5146 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5147 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5148 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5149 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5150 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5151
5152 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5153 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5154 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5155 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5156
5157 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5158 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5159 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5160 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5161
5162 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5163 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5164 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5165
5166 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5167 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5168 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5169
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005170 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5171
5172
5173option tcp-smart-connect
5174no option tcp-smart-connect
5175 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5177 yes | no | yes | yes
5178 Arguments : none
5179
5180 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5181 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5182 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5183 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5184 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5185
5186 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5187 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5188 complex.
5189
5190 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5191 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5192 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5193
5194 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5195 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5196
5197 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5198
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005199
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005200option tcpka
5201 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5203 yes | yes | yes | yes
5204 Arguments : none
5205
5206 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5207 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5208 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5209 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5210
5211 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5212 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5213 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5214 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5215
5216 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5217 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5218 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5219 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5220 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5221
5222 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5223
5224 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5225 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5226 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5227 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5228 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5229 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5230 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5231 backends.
5232
5233 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5234
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005235
5236option tcplog
5237 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5239 yes | yes | yes | yes
5240 Arguments : none
5241
5242 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5243 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5244 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5245 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5246 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5247 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5248 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5249 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5250
5251 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005253 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005254
5255
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005256option transparent
5257no option transparent
5258 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005260 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005261 Arguments : none
5262
5263 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5264 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5265 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5266 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5267 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5268 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5269 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5270 appropriate server.
5271
5272 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5273 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5274
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005275 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005276 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005277
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005278
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005279persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005280persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005281 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5283 yes | no | yes | yes
5284 Arguments :
5285 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005286 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5287 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005288
5289 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5290 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5291 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5292 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5293 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5294 forwarded to this server.
5295
5296 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5297 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5298 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005299 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005300 a single "listen" section.
5301
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005302 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5303 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5304 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5305
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005306 Example :
5307 listen tse-farm
5308 bind :3389
5309 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5310 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5311 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5312 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5313 persist rdp-cookie
5314 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005315 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005316 balance rdp-cookie
5317 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5318 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5319
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005320 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5321 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005322
5323
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005324rate-limit sessions <rate>
5325 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5327 yes | yes | yes | no
5328 Arguments :
5329 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5330 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5331
5332 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5333 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5334 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5335 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5336 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5337 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5338
5339 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5340 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5341 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5342 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5343
5344 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5345 listen smtp
5346 mode tcp
5347 bind :25
5348 rate-limit sessions 10
5349 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5350
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005351 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5352 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5353 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005354
5355 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5356
5357
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005358redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5359redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5360redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005361 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5363 no | yes | yes | yes
5364
5365 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005366 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005367
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005368 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005369 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005370 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5371 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5372 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005373
5374 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5375 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5376 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5377 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5378 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005379 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5380 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5381 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5382 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005383
5384 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5385 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5386 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5387 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5388 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5389 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005390 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005391 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005392 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5393 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5394 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005395
5396 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005397 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5398 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5399 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5400 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5401 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5402 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5403 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5404 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005405
5406 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5407 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5408
5409 - "drop-query"
5410 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5411 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5412 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5413 with a location-type redirect.
5414
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005415 - "append-slash"
5416 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5417 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5418 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5419 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5420
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005421 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5422 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5423 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5424 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5425 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5426 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5427 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5428
5429 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5430 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5431 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5432 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5433 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5434 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5435 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005436
5437 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5438 acl clear dst_port 80
5439 acl secure dst_port 8080
5440 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005441 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005442 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005443 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5444
5445 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005446 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5447 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5448 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005449 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005450
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005451 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5452 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5453 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5454
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005455 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005456 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005457
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005458 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5459 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5460 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005462 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005463
5464
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005465redisp (deprecated)
5466redispatch (deprecated)
5467 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5468 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5469 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005470 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005471
5472 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5473 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5474 be able to access the service anymore.
5475
5476 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5477 redistribute them to a working server.
5478
5479 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5480 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5481 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005482
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005483 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5484 "option redispatch" instead.
5485
5486 See also : "option redispatch"
5487
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005488
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005489reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005490 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5492 no | yes | yes | yes
5493 Arguments :
5494 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5495 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005496 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005497
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005498 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5499 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5500
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005501 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5502 the last header of an HTTP request.
5503
5504 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5505 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5506 responses.
5507
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005508 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5509 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5510 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5511
5512 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5513 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005514
5515
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005516reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5517reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005518 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5520 no | yes | yes | yes
5521 Arguments :
5522 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5523 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5524 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5525 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5526 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5527 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5528 ignores case.
5529
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005530 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5531 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5532
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005533 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5534 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5535 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5536 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005537 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005538
5539 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5540 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5541
5542 Example :
5543 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5544 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5545 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5546
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005547 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5548 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005549
5550
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005551reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5552reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005553 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5555 no | yes | yes | yes
5556 Arguments :
5557 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5558 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5559 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5560 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5561 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5562 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5563
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005564 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5565 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5566
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005567 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5568 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5569 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5570 next servers.
5571
5572 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5573 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5574 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5575
5576 Example :
5577 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5578 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5579 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5580
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005581 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5582 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005583
5584
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005585reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5586reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005587 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5589 no | yes | yes | yes
5590 Arguments :
5591 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5592 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5593 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5594 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5595 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5596 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5597 case.
5598
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005599 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5600 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5601
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005602 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5603 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5604 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5605 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005606 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005607
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005608 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005609 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005610 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005611
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005612 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5613 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5614
5615 Example :
5616 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5617 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5618 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5619
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005620 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5621 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005622
5623
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005624reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5625reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005626 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5628 no | yes | yes | yes
5629 Arguments :
5630 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5631 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5632 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5633 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5634 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5635 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5636 case.
5637
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005638 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5639 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5640
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005641 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5642 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5643 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5644 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5645
5646 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5647 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5648
5649 Example :
5650 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5651 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5652 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5653 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5654
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005655 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5656 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005657
5658
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005659reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5660reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005661 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5663 no | yes | yes | yes
5664 Arguments :
5665 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5666 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5667 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5668 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5669 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5670 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5671
5672 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5673 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5674 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5675 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005676 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005677
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005678 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5679 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5680
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005681 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5682 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5683 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5684
5685 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5686 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5687 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5688 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5689 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5690
5691 Example :
5692 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005693 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005694 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5695 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5696
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005697 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5698 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005699
5700
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005701reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5702reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005703 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5705 no | yes | yes | yes
5706 Arguments :
5707 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5708 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5709 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5710 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5711 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5712 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5713 ignores case.
5714
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005715 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5716 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5717
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005718 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5719 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005720 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5721 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5722 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005723 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5724 not set.
5725
5726 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5727 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5728 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5729 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5730 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5731
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005732 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005733 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5734 # block all others.
5735 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5736 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5737
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005738 # block bad guys
5739 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5740 reqitarpit . if badguys
5741
5742 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5743 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005744
5745
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005746retries <value>
5747 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5748 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5749 yes | no | yes | yes
5750 Arguments :
5751 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5752 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5753 default value is 3.
5754
5755 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5756 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5757 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5758
5759 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5760 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5761
5762 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5763 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5764
5765 See also : "option redispatch"
5766
5767
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005768rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005769 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5771 no | yes | yes | yes
5772 Arguments :
5773 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5774 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005775 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005776
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005777 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5778 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5779
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005780 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5781 the last header of an HTTP response.
5782
5783 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5784 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5785 responses.
5786
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005787 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5788 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005789
5790
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005791rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5792rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005793 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5795 no | yes | yes | yes
5796 Arguments :
5797 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5798 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5799 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5800 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5801 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5802 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5803 ignores case.
5804
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005805 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5806 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5807
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005808 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5809 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005810 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005811 client.
5812
5813 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5814 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5815 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5816
5817 Example :
5818 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005819 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005820
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005821 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5822 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005823
5824
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005825rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5826rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005827 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5829 no | yes | yes | yes
5830 Arguments :
5831 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5832 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5833 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5834 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5835 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5836 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5837 ignores case.
5838
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005839 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5840 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5841
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005842 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5843 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5844 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5845 case-sensitive.
5846
5847 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005848 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5849 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5850 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005851
5852 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5853 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5854
5855 Example :
5856 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5857 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5858
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005859 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5860 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005861
5862
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005863rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5864rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005865 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5867 no | yes | yes | yes
5868 Arguments :
5869 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5870 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5871 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5872 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5873 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5874 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5875 ignores case.
5876
5877 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5878 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5879 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5880 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005881 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005882
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005883 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5884 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5885
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005886 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5887 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5888 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5889
5890 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5891 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5892 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5893 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5894 are not case-sensitive.
5895
5896 Example :
5897 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5898 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5899
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005900 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5901 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005902
5903
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005904server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005905 Declare a server in a backend
5906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5907 no | no | yes | yes
5908 Arguments :
5909 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005910 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005911 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005912
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005913 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5914 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5915 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5916 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005917 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5918 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5919 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5920 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5921 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005922 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5923 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5924 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5925 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5926 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5927 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5928 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005929 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005930 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5931 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5932 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5933 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005934
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005935 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005936 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5937 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5938 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5939 adding this value to the client's port.
5940
5941 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5942 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005943 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005944
5945 Examples :
5946 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5947 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005948 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005949 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5950 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5951 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005952
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005953 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5954 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005955
5956
5957source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005958source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005959source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005960 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5962 yes | no | yes | yes
5963 Arguments :
5964 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5965 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005966
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005967 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005968 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5969 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5970 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5971 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5972 supported prefixes are :
5973 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5974 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5975 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005976 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005977 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5978 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5979 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5980 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005981
5982 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5983 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005984 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5985 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5986 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005987
5988 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5989 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5990 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5991 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5992 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5993 <addr>.
5994
5995 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5996 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5997 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5998 port.
5999
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006000 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6001 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6002 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6003 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006004 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006005 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6006 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6007 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6008 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6009 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6010 HTTP header.
6011
6012 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6013 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006014 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006015 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6016 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6017 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6018 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6019 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6020 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6021 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6022
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006023 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6024 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6025 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6026 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6027 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6028 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6029
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006030 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6031 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6032 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6033 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6034
6035 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6036 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6037 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6038 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6039 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6040 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6041
6042 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6043 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6044 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6045 there are two methods :
6046
6047 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6048 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6049 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6050 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6051 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6052 of the client ranges may be used.
6053
6054 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6055 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6056 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6057 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6058 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6059 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6060 same session.
6061
6062 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6063 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6064 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6065 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6066 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6067 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6068
6069 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6070 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6071 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006072 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006073
6074 Examples :
6075 backend private
6076 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6077 source 192.168.1.200
6078
6079 backend transparent_ssl1
6080 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6081 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6082
6083 backend transparent_ssl2
6084 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6085 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6086 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6087
6088 backend transparent_ssl3
6089 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6090 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6091 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6092
6093 backend transparent_smtp
6094 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6095 # with Tproxy version 4.
6096 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6097
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006098 backend transparent_http
6099 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6100 # proxy.
6101 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6102
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006103 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006104 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6105
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006106
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006107srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6108 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6110 yes | no | yes | yes
6111 Arguments :
6112 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6113 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6114 as explained at the top of this document.
6115
6116 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6117 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6118 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6119 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6120 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6121 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6122 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6123
6124 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6125 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6126 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6127 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6128 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006129 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006130 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006131 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006132
6133 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6134 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6135 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6136 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6137 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6138 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6139
6140 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6141 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6142
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006143 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6144 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006145
6146
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006147stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6148 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006150 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006151
6152 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6153 matched.
6154
6155 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6156 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6157
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006158 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6159 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6160 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6161
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006162 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6163 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6164 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6165 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006166
6167 Example :
6168 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6169 backend stats_localhost
6170 stats enable
6171 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6172
6173 Example :
6174 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6175 backend stats_auth
6176 stats enable
6177 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6178 stats admin if TRUE
6179
6180 Example :
6181 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6182 userlist stats-auth
6183 group admin users admin
6184 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6185 group readonly users haproxy
6186 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6187
6188 backend stats_auth
6189 stats enable
6190 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6191 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6192 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6193 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6194
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006195 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6196 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6197 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006198
6199
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006200stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6201 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006203 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006204 Arguments :
6205 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6206
6207 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6208
6209 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6210 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6211 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6212 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6213 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6214 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6215
6216 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6217 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6218 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006219 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006220
6221 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6222 report using "stats scope".
6223
6224 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6225 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6226 unobvious parameters.
6227
6228 Example :
6229 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6230 backend public_www
6231 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6232 stats enable
6233 stats hide-version
6234 stats scope .
6235 stats uri /admin?stats
6236 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6237 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6238 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6239
6240 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6241 backend private_monitoring
6242 stats enable
6243 stats uri /admin?stats
6244 stats refresh 5s
6245
6246 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6247
6248
6249stats enable
6250 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006252 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006253 Arguments : none
6254
6255 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6256 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6257 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6258 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6259 - stats auth : no authentication
6260 - stats scope : no restriction
6261
6262 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6263 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6264 unobvious parameters.
6265
6266 Example :
6267 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6268 backend public_www
6269 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6270 stats enable
6271 stats hide-version
6272 stats scope .
6273 stats uri /admin?stats
6274 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6275 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6276 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6277
6278 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6279 backend private_monitoring
6280 stats enable
6281 stats uri /admin?stats
6282 stats refresh 5s
6283
6284 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6285
6286
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006287stats hide-version
6288 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006290 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006291 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006292
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006293 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6294 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6295 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6296 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6297 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6298 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006299
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006300 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6301 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6302 unobvious parameters.
6303
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006304 Example :
6305 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6306 backend public_www
6307 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006308 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006309 stats hide-version
6310 stats scope .
6311 stats uri /admin?stats
6312 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6313 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6314 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006315
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006316 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6317 backend private_monitoring
6318 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006319 stats uri /admin?stats
6320 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006321
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006322 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006323
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006324
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006325stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6326 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6327 Access control for statistics
6328
6329 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6330 no | no | yes | yes
6331
6332 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6333 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6334 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6335 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6336 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6337 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6338
6339 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6340 instance.
6341
6342 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6343 about ACL usage.
6344
6345
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006346stats realm <realm>
6347 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006349 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006350 Arguments :
6351 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6352 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6353 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6354
6355 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6356 using a backslash ('\').
6357
6358 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6359 only related to authentication.
6360
6361 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6362 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6363 unobvious parameters.
6364
6365 Example :
6366 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6367 backend public_www
6368 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6369 stats enable
6370 stats hide-version
6371 stats scope .
6372 stats uri /admin?stats
6373 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6374 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6375 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6376
6377 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6378 backend private_monitoring
6379 stats enable
6380 stats uri /admin?stats
6381 stats refresh 5s
6382
6383 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6384
6385
6386stats refresh <delay>
6387 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006389 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006390 Arguments :
6391 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6392 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6393 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6394 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6395 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6396 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6397
6398 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6399 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6400 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6401 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6402
6403 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6404 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6405 unobvious parameters.
6406
6407 Example :
6408 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6409 backend public_www
6410 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6411 stats enable
6412 stats hide-version
6413 stats scope .
6414 stats uri /admin?stats
6415 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6416 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6417 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6418
6419 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6420 backend private_monitoring
6421 stats enable
6422 stats uri /admin?stats
6423 stats refresh 5s
6424
6425 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6426
6427
6428stats scope { <name> | "." }
6429 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006431 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006432 Arguments :
6433 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6434 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6435 section in which the statement appears.
6436
6437 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6438 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6439 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6440 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6441 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6442 exists.
6443
6444 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6445 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6446 unobvious parameters.
6447
6448 Example :
6449 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6450 backend public_www
6451 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6452 stats enable
6453 stats hide-version
6454 stats scope .
6455 stats uri /admin?stats
6456 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6457 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6458 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6459
6460 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6461 backend private_monitoring
6462 stats enable
6463 stats uri /admin?stats
6464 stats refresh 5s
6465
6466 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6467
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006468
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006469stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006470 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006472 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006473
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006474 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006475 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6476
6477 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6478 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6479
6480 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6481 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006482 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006483
6484 Example :
6485 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6486 backend private_monitoring
6487 stats enable
6488 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6489 stats uri /admin?stats
6490 stats refresh 5s
6491
6492 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6493 global section.
6494
6495
6496stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006497 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6499 yes | yes | yes | yes
6500 Arguments : none
6501
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006502 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006503 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6504 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6505 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6506 - IP (socket, server)
6507 - cookie (backend, server)
6508
6509 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6510 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006511 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006512
6513 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6514
6515
6516stats show-node [ <name> ]
6517 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006519 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006520 Arguments:
6521 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6522 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6523
6524 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6525 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006526 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006527
6528 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6529 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6530 unobvious parameters.
6531
6532 Example:
6533 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6534 backend private_monitoring
6535 stats enable
6536 stats show-node Europe-1
6537 stats uri /admin?stats
6538 stats refresh 5s
6539
6540 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6541 section.
6542
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006543
6544stats uri <prefix>
6545 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006547 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006548 Arguments :
6549 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6550 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6551 query string.
6552
6553 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6554 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6555 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6556 possible to reach it in the application.
6557
6558 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006559 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006560 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6561 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6562 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6563 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6564
6565 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6566 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6567 an address or a port to statistics only.
6568
6569 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6570 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6571 unobvious parameters.
6572
6573 Example :
6574 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6575 backend public_www
6576 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6577 stats enable
6578 stats hide-version
6579 stats scope .
6580 stats uri /admin?stats
6581 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6582 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6583 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6584
6585 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6586 backend private_monitoring
6587 stats enable
6588 stats uri /admin?stats
6589 stats refresh 5s
6590
6591 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6592
6593
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006594stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6595 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006597 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006598
6599 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006600 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006601 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6602 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6603 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6604
6605 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6606 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6607 the "stick-table" statement.
6608
6609 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6610 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6611 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6612 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6613 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6614
6615 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6616 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6617 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6618 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6619 transformation rules.
6620
6621 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6622 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6623 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6624 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6625 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6626 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6627 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6628
6629 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6630 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6631 ACL based conditions.
6632
6633 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6634 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6635 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6636 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6637
6638 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6639 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6640 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6641 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6642
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006643 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6644 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6645 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6646
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006647 Example :
6648 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6649 # last 30 minutes
6650 backend pop
6651 mode tcp
6652 balance roundrobin
6653 stick store-request src
6654 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6655 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6656 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6657
6658 backend smtp
6659 mode tcp
6660 balance roundrobin
6661 stick match src table pop
6662 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6663 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6664
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006665 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006666 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006667
6668
6669stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6670 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6672 no | no | yes | yes
6673
6674 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6675 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6676 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6677 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6678
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006679 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6680 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6681 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6682
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006683 Examples :
6684 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006685 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006686
6687 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6688 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6689 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6690
6691
6692 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6693 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6694 backend http
6695 mode http
6696 balance roundrobin
6697 stick on src table https
6698 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6699 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6700 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6701
6702 backend https
6703 mode tcp
6704 balance roundrobin
6705 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6706 stick on src
6707 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6708 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6709
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006710 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006711
6712
6713stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6714 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6716 no | no | yes | yes
6717
6718 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006719 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006720 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6721 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6722 server is selected.
6723
6724 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6725 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6726 the "stick-table" statement.
6727
6728 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6729 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6730 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6731 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6732 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6733 address.
6734
6735 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6736 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6737 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6738 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6739 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6740 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6741 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6742 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6743 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6744 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6745
6746 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6747 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6748 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6749 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6750 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6751 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6752 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6753
6754 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6755 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6756 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6757 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6758
6759 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6760 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6761 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6762 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6763 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6764 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006765 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6766 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6767 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6768 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6769 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6770 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006771
6772 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6773 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6774 the request.
6775
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006776 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6777 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6778 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6779
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006780 Example :
6781 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6782 # last 30 minutes
6783 backend pop
6784 mode tcp
6785 balance roundrobin
6786 stick store-request src
6787 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6788 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6789 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6790
6791 backend smtp
6792 mode tcp
6793 balance roundrobin
6794 stick match src table pop
6795 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6796 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6797
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006798 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006799 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006800
6801
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006802stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006803 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6804 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006805 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006807 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006808
6809 Arguments :
6810 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6811 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6812 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6813 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6814
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006815 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6816 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6817 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6818 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6819
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006820 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6821 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6822 instance.
6823
6824 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6825 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6826 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6827 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6828 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6829 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006830 to 32 characters.
6831
6832 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6833 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6834 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006835 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006836 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6837 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006838
6839 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006840 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6841 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006842 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6843 increase.
6844
6845 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006846 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6847 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6848 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006849
6850 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6851 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6852 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6853 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6854 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6855 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6856 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6857 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6858 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6859 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6860 parameter (see below).
6861
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006862 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6863 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6864 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6865 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6866 soft restart.
6867
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006868 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6869
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006870 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6871 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6872 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6873 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6874 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006875 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006876 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6877 if not expiration delay is specified.
6878
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006879 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6880 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6881 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6882 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006883 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6884 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6885 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6886 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6887 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6888 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6889 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6890 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6891 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6892 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6893 types and their arguments.
6894
6895 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6896 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6897 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6898 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6899
6900 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6901 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6902 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6903 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6904
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006905 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6906 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6907 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6908 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6909 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6910 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6911
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006912 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6913 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6914 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6915 they were received.
6916
6917 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6918 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6919 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6920 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6921 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6922
6923 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6924 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6925 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6926 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6927 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6928
6929 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6930 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6931 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6932
6933 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6934 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6935 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6936 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6937 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6938
6939 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6940 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6941 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6942 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6943 the client side.
6944
6945 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6946 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6947 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6948 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6949 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6950 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6951 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6952
6953 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6954 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6955 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6956 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6957 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6958 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6959 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6960
6961 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6962 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6963 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6964 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6965 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6966 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6967
6968 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6969 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6970 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6971 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6972
6973 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6974 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6975 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6976 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6977 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6978 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6979 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6980 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6981 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6982 recommended for better fairness.
6983
6984 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6985 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6986 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6987 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6988
6989 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6990 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6991 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6992 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6993 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6994 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6995 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6996 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6997 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6998 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006999
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007000 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7001 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007002 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7003 reference it.
7004
7005 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7006 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7007 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7008 as an exclusive stickiness.
7009
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007010 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7011 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7012 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7013 something that can be ignored.
7014
7015 Example:
7016 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7017 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7018 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7019 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7020
7021 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007022 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007023
7024
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007025stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7026 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7028 no | no | yes | yes
7029
7030 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007031 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007032 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7033 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7034 server is selected.
7035
7036 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7037 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7038 the "stick-table" statement.
7039
7040 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7041 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7042 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7043 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7044
7045 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7046 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7047 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7048 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7049 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7050 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007051 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007052 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7053 rules.
7054
7055 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7056 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7057 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7058 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7059 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7060 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7061 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7062
7063 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7064 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7065 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7066 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7067
7068 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7069 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7070 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7071 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7072 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7073 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007074 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7075 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7076 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7077 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7078 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7079 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7080 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7081 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7082 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007083
7084 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7085
7086 Example :
7087 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7088 backend https
7089 mode tcp
7090 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007091 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007092 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007093
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007094 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7095 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7096
7097 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7098 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7099 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7100
7101 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7102 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007103
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007104 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7105 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7106 # at offset 44.
7107
7108 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7109 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7110
7111 # Learn on response if server hello.
7112 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007113
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007114 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7115 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7116
7117 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7118 extraction.
7119
7120
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007121tcp-check connect [params*]
7122 Opens a new connection
7123 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7124 no | no | yes | yes
7125
7126 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7127 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7128 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7129
7130 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7131 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7132 of the sequence.
7133
7134 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7135 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7136 do.
7137
7138 Parameters :
7139 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7140 use the TCP connection.
7141
7142 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7143 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7144 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7145
7146 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7147
7148 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7149
7150 Examples:
7151 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7152 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7153 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7154 option tcp-check
7155 tcp-check connect
7156 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7157 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7158 tcp-check send \r\n
7159 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7160 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7161 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7162 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7163 tcp-check send \r\n
7164 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7165 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7166
7167 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7168 option tcp-check
7169 tcp-check connect port 110
7170 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7171 tcp-check connect port 143
7172 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7173 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7174
7175 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7176
7177
7178tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7179 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7180 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7181 no | no | yes | yes
7182
7183 Arguments :
7184 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7185 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7186 binary.
7187 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7188 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7189 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7190
7191 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7192 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7193 with the usual backslash ('\').
7194 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7195 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7196 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7197 used upper or lower case.
7198
7199
7200 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7201
7202 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7203 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7204 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7205 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7206 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7207 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7208 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7209 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7210
7211 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7212 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7213 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7214 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7215 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7216 expression.
7217
7218 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7219 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7220 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7221 this exact hexadecimal string.
7222 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7223
7224 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7225 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7226 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7227 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7228 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7229 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7230 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7231 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7232 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7233 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7234 the null character.
7235
7236 Examples :
7237 # perform a POP check
7238 option tcp-check
7239 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7240
7241 # perform an IMAP check
7242 option tcp-check
7243 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7244
7245 # look for the redis master server
7246 option tcp-check
7247 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7248 tcp-check expect +PONG
7249 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7250 tcp-check expect string role:master
7251 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7252 tcp-check expect string +OK
7253
7254
7255 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7256 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7257
7258
7259tcp-check send <data>
7260 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7261 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7262 no | no | yes | yes
7263
7264 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7265 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7266
7267 Examples :
7268 # look for the redis master server
7269 option tcp-check
7270 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7271 tcp-check expect string role:master
7272
7273 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7274 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7275
7276
7277tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7278 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7279 tcp health check
7280 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7281 no | no | yes | yes
7282
7283 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7284 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7285 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7286 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7287 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7288 hexadecimal string.
7289 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7290
7291 Examples :
7292 # redis check in binary
7293 option tcp-check
7294 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7295 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7296
7297
7298 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7299 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7300
7301
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007302tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7303 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7305 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007306 Arguments :
7307 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007308 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7309 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007310
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007311 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007312
7313 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7314 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007315 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7316 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7317 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7318 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7319 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7320 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007321
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007322 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7323 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7324 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7325 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007326
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007327 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007328 - accept :
7329 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7330 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7331 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007332
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007333 - reject :
7334 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7335 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7336 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7337 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7338 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7339 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7340 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7341 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7342 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7343 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7344 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7345 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007346
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007347 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7348 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7349 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7350 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7351 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7352 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7353 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7354 hosts.
7355
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007356 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7357 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7358 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7359 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7360 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7361 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7362 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7363 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7364 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7365 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7366 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7367
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007368 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007369 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7370 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7371 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007372 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7373 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007374 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007375 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7376 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7377 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7378 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7379 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007380
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007381 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007382 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007383 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007384 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7385 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7386 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7387 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007388
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007389 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7390 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7391 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7392 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007393
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007394 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7395 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7396 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7397 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7398 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007399 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7400 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7401 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7402 layer7 information is extracted.
7403
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007404 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7405 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7406 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7407 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7408 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007409
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007410 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7411 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7412 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007413
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007414 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7415 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7416 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007417
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007418 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007419 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007420 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007421
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007422 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7423 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7424 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007425
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007426 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007427 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7428 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007429
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007430 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7431
7432 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7433
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007434 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7435
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007436 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007437
7438
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007439tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7440 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007442 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007443 Arguments :
7444 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007445 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007446 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7447 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007448
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007449 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007450
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007451 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7452 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7453 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7454 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7455 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007456
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007457 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7458 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7459 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7460 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007461 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7462 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7463 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7464 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7465 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7466 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007467 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007468 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007469
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007470 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7471 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7472 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7473 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007474
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007475 Four types of actions are supported :
7476 - accept : the request is accepted
7477 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7478 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007479 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007480
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007481 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7482 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007483
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007484 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7485 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7486 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7487 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7488 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7489 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007491 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007492 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7493 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007494
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007495 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007496 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7497 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7498 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7499 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007500 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7501 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7502 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007503
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007504 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007505 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7506 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7507 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007508
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007509 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007510 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7511 # and reject everything else.
7512 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7513 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007514 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007515 tcp-request content reject
7516
7517 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007518 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7519 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7520 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007521 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007522
7523 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7524 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7525 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007526 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007527 tcp-request content reject
7528
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007529 Example:
7530 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7531 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007532 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007533
7534 Example:
7535 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7536 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007537 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007538
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007539 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7540 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7541
7542 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007543 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007544 # protecting all our sites
7545 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007546 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7547 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007548 ...
7549 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7550
7551 backend http_dynamic
7552 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007553 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007554 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007555 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7556 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7557 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007558 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007560 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007561
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007562 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007563
7564
7565tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7566 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007568 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007569 Arguments :
7570 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7571 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7572 as explained at the top of this document.
7573
7574 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7575 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7576 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7577 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7578 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7579
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007580 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7581 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7582 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7583 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7584
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007585 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7586 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007587 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007588 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007589 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7590 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7591 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7592 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007593
7594 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7595 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7596 it pass through unaffected.
7597
7598 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7599 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7600 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007601 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007602 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7603 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007604 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7605 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7606 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007607
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007608 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007609 "timeout client".
7610
7611
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007612tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7613 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7615 no | no | yes | yes
7616 Arguments :
7617 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007618 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007619
7620 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7621
7622 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7623 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7624 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007625 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7626 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007627
7628 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7629
7630 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7631 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7632 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7633 inserted.
7634
7635 Two types of actions are supported :
7636 - accept :
7637 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7638 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7639 the rules evaluation.
7640
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007641 - close :
7642 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7643 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7644 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7645 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7646 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7647 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007648 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007649 protocols.
7650
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007651 - reject :
7652 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7653 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007654 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007655
7656 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7657 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7658 for changing the default action to a reject.
7659
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007660 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7661 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7662 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7663 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007664 period.
7665
7666 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7667
7668 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7669
7670
7671tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7672 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7674 no | no | yes | yes
7675 Arguments :
7676 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7677 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7678 as explained at the top of this document.
7679
7680 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7681
7682
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007683timeout check <timeout>
7684 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7685 established.
7686
7687 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7688 yes | no | yes | yes
7689 Arguments:
7690 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7691 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7692 as explained at the top of this document.
7693
7694 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7695 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7696 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7697 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007698 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7699 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7700 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007701
7702 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7703 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7704
7705 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7706 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007707 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007708
7709 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7710 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7711 forget about it.
7712
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007713 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7714 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007715
7716
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007717timeout client <timeout>
7718timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7719 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7721 yes | yes | yes | no
7722 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007723 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007724 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7725 as explained at the top of this document.
7726
7727 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7728 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7729 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7730 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7731 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7732 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7733 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7734 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007735 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007736 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007737 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7738 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007739 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7740 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007741
7742 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7743 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7744 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7745 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7746 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7747 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7748
7749 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7750 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7751 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7752
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007753 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007754
7755
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007756timeout client-fin <timeout>
7757 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7759 yes | yes | yes | no
7760 Arguments :
7761 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7762 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7763 as explained at the top of this document.
7764
7765 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7766 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7767 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7768 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7769 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7770 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7771 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7772 down in one direction.
7773
7774 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7775 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7776 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7777
7778 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7779
7780
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007781timeout connect <timeout>
7782timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7783 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7785 yes | no | yes | yes
7786 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007787 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007788 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7789 as explained at the top of this document.
7790
7791 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007792 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007793 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007794 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007795 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7796 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007797
7798 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7799 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7800 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7801 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7802 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7803 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7804
7805 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7806 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7807 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7808
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007809 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7810 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007811
7812
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007813timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7814 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7816 yes | yes | yes | yes
7817 Arguments :
7818 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7819 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7820 as explained at the top of this document.
7821
7822 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7823 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7824 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7825 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7826 once the request has started to present itself.
7827
7828 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7829 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7830 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7831 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7832 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7833
7834 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7835 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7836 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7837 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7838
7839 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7840 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7841 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7842 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7843 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007844 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007845
7846 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7847 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7848 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7849 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7850
7851 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7852
7853
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007854timeout http-request <timeout>
7855 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007857 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007858 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007859 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007860 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7861 as explained at the top of this document.
7862
7863 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7864 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7865 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7866 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7867 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7868 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7869 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007870 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7871 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7872 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7873 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7874 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7875 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7876 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007877
7878 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7879 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007880 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7881 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007882
7883 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7884 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7885 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7886 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7887 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7888
7889 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007890 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7891 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7892 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007893
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007894 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007895
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007896
7897timeout queue <timeout>
7898 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7900 yes | no | yes | yes
7901 Arguments :
7902 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7903 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7904 as explained at the top of this document.
7905
7906 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7907 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7908 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7909 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7910 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7911
7912 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7913 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7914 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7915 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7916
7917 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7918
7919
7920timeout server <timeout>
7921timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7922 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7924 yes | no | yes | yes
7925 Arguments :
7926 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7927 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7928 as explained at the top of this document.
7929
7930 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7931 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7932 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7933 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7934 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7935 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7936 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7937
7938 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7939 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7940 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7941 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7942 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007943 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007944 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007945 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7946 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7947 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7948 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007949
7950 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7951 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7952 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7953 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7954 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7955 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7956
7957 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7958 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7959 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7960
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007961 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007962
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007963
7964timeout server-fin <timeout>
7965 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
7966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7967 yes | no | yes | yes
7968 Arguments :
7969 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7970 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7971 as explained at the top of this document.
7972
7973 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7974 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7975 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7976 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7977 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
7978 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7979 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7980 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
7981 situations, it should not be needed.
7982
7983 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7984 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7985 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
7986
7987 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
7988
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007989
7990timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007991 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7993 yes | yes | yes | yes
7994 Arguments :
7995 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7996 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7997 as explained at the top of this document.
7998
7999 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8000 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8001 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8002
8003 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8004 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8005 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8006 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008007 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008008
8009 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8010
8011
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008012timeout tunnel <timeout>
8013 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8015 yes | no | yes | yes
8016 Arguments :
8017 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8018 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8019 as explained at the top of this document.
8020
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008021 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008022 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8023 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8024 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8025 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8026 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8027 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8028 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8029 specified.
8030
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008031 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8032 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8033 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8034 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8035 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8036 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8037 state.
8038
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008039 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8040 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8041 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8042 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8043 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8044
8045 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8046 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8047 forget about it.
8048
8049 Example :
8050 defaults http
8051 option http-server-close
8052 timeout connect 5s
8053 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008054 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008055 timeout server 30s
8056 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8057
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008058 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008059
8060
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008061transparent (deprecated)
8062 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008064 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008065 Arguments : none
8066
8067 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8068 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8069 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8070 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8071 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8072 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8073 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8074 appropriate server.
8075
8076 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8077
8078 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8079 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8080
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008081 See also: "option transparent"
8082
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008083unique-id-format <string>
8084 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8086 yes | yes | yes | no
8087 Arguments :
8088 <string> is a log-format string.
8089
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008090 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8091 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8092 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8093 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008094
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008095 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8096 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8097 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8098 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8099 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8100 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8101 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8102 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008103
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008104 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8105 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008106
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008107 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008108
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008109 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008110
8111 will generate:
8112
8113 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8114
8115 See also: "unique-id-header"
8116
8117unique-id-header <name>
8118 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8120 yes | yes | yes | no
8121 Arguments :
8122 <name> is the name of the header.
8123
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008124 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8125 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008126
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008127 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008128
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008129 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008130 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8131
8132 will generate:
8133
8134 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8135
8136 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008137
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008138use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008139 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8141 no | yes | yes | no
8142 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008143 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8144 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008145
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008146 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8147 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008148
8149 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8150 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8151 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008152 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8153 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8154 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8155 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008156
8157 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8158 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8159 assign the backend.
8160
8161 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8162 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8163 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8164 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8165 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8166 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8167
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008168 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008169 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008170 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8171 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8172 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8173
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008174 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8175 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8176 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8177 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8178 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8179 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8180 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8181 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8182 cannot be forced from the request.
8183
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008184 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008185 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8186 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8187
8188 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8189 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008190
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008191
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008192use-server <server> if <condition>
8193use-server <server> unless <condition>
8194 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8196 no | no | yes | yes
8197 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008198 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008199
8200 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8201
8202 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8203 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8204 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8205
8206 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8207 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8208 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8209 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8210 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8211 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8212 matches will assign the server.
8213
8214 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8215 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8216 with the next rules until one matches.
8217
8218 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8219 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8220 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8221 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8222
8223 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8224 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8225 stripped.
8226
8227 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8228 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8229 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8230 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8231
8232 Example :
8233 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8234 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8235 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8236 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8237 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8238 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8239 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8240 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8241 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8242
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008243 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008244
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008245
82465. Bind and Server options
8247--------------------------
8248
8249The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8250depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8251settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8252written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8253described in this section.
8254
8255
82565.1. Bind options
8257-----------------
8258
8259The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8260as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8261no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8262parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8263while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8264provided immediately after the setting name.
8265
8266The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8267
8268accept-proxy
8269 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008270 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8271 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008272 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8273 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8274 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8275 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8276 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8277 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8278 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008279 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8280 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008281
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008282alpn <protocols>
8283 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8284 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8285 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8286 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8287 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8288 initial NPN extension.
8289
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008290backlog <backlog>
8291 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8292 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8293
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008294ecdhe <named curve>
8295 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008296 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8297 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008298
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008299ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008300 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8301 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8302 client's certificate.
8303
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008304ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8306 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8307 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8308 error is ignored.
8309
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008310ciphers <ciphers>
8311 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8312 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008313 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008314 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8315 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8316
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008317crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8319 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8320 to verify client's certificate.
8321
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008322crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008323 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8324 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8325 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8326 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8327 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8328 file.
8329
8330 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8331 are loaded.
8332
8333 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté62043c92015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008334 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
8335 '.issuer' or '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified
8336 multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
8337 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
8338 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects.
8339 Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the
8340 first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008341 www.sub.example.org).
8342
8343 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8344 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8345 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8346 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté62043c92015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008347 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
8348 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008349
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008350 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008351
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008352 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8353 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008354 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008355 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8356 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8357 clients).
8358
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008359 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8360 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8361 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8362 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8363 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8364 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8365 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8366 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8367 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8368 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8369 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8370 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8371 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8372
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008373crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008374 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8375 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008376 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008377 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008378
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008379crt-list <file>
8380 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008381 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8382 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008383
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008384 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008385
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008386 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8387 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8388 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8389 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8390 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8391 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8392 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8393 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008394
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008395defer-accept
8396 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8397 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8398 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8399 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8400 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8401 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8402 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8403 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8404 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8405 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8406 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8407
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008408force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008409 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008410 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008411 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8412 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008413
8414force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008415 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008416 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8417 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008418
8419force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008420 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008421 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8422 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008423
8424force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008425 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008426 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8427 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008428
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008429gid <gid>
8430 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8431 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8432 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8433 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8434 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8435
8436group <group>
8437 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8438 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8439 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8440 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8441 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8442
8443id <id>
8444 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8445 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8446 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8447 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8448
8449interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008450 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8451 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8452 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8453 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8454 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8455 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8456 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008457
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008458level <level>
8459 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8460 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8461 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8462 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8463 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8464 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8465 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8466 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8467 counters).
8468 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8469 all counters).
8470
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008471maxconn <maxconn>
8472 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8473 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8474 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8475 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8476 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8477 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8478 eat all memory.
8479
8480mode <mode>
8481 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8482 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8483 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8484 UNIX sockets.
8485
8486mss <maxseg>
8487 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8488 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8489 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8490 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8491 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8492 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8493 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8494 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8495 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8496 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8497 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8498
8499name <name>
8500 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8501 page.
8502
8503nice <nice>
8504 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8505 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8506 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8507 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8508 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8509 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8510 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8511 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8512 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8513 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8514 one for an RDP socket.
8515
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008516no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008517 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008518 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008519 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008520 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8521 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008522 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008523
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008524no-tls-tickets
8525 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8526 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8527 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008528 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8529 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008530
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008531no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008532 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008533 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008534 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008535 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8536 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8537 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008538
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008539no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008540 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008541 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008542 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008543 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8544 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8545 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008546
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008547no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008548 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008549 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008550 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008551 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8552 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8553 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008554
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008555npn <protocols>
8556 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8557 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8558 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8559 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008560 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8561 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008562
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008563process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8564 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8565 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8566 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8567 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8568 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8569 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8570 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008571 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8572 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8573 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8574 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8575 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8576 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8577 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008578
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008579ssl
8580 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008581 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008582 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8583 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8584 to deciphered contents.
8585
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008586strict-sni
8587 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8588 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8589 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8590 See the "crt" option for more information.
8591
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008592tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008593 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008594 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8595 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8596 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8597 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8598 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8599 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8600 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008601 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8602 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8603 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008604
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008605transparent
8606 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8607 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8608 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8609 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8610 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8611 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8612 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8613 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8614 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8615 so check for support with your vendor.
8616
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008617v4v6
8618 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8619 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8620 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8621 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008622 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008623
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008624v6only
8625 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8626 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8627 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008628 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8629 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008630
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008631uid <uid>
8632 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8633 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8634 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8635 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8636 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8637
8638user <user>
8639 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8640 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8641 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8642 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8643 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8644
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008645verify [none|optional|required]
8646 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8647 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8648 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8649 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8650 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008651 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8652 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8653 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8654 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008655
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020086565.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008657------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008659The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8660which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8661arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8662settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8663after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8664Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8665address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008666
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008667 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008668 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008669
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008670The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008671
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008672addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008673 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8674 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8675 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8676 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8677 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008679 Supported in default-server: No
8680
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008681agent-check
8682 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008683 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8684 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8685 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8686 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008687
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008688 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008689 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreau47067ca2014-10-07 15:27:33 +02008690 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
8691 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
8692 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008693
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008694 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8695 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008696
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008697 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8698 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8699 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008700
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008701 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8702 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8703 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008704
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008705 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8706 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8707 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8708 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8709 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8710 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8711 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008712
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008713 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8714 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008715
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008716 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8717 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8718 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8719 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8720 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8721 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8722 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8723 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8724 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008725
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008726 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8727 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008728 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8729 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8730 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8731 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008732
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008733 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8734 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008735
8736 Supported in default-server: No
8737
8738agent-inter <delay>
8739 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8740 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8741
8742 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8743 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8744 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8745 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8746 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8747 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8748 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8749 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8750 of backends use the same servers.
8751
8752 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8753
8754 Supported in default-server: Yes
8755
8756agent-port <port>
8757 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8758
8759 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8760
8761 Supported in default-server: Yes
8762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008763backup
8764 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8765 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8766 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8767 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8768 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8769 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008770
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008771 Supported in default-server: No
8772
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008773ca-file <cafile>
8774 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8775 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8776 server's certificate.
8777
8778 Supported in default-server: No
8779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008780check
8781 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008782 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8783 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8784 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8785 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8786 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8787 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8788 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008789 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8790 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8791 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008792
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008793 Supported in default-server: No
8794
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008795check-send-proxy
8796 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8797 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8798 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8799 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8800 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8801 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8802 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8803
8804 Supported in default-server: No
8805
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008806check-ssl
8807 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8808 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8809 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8810 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008811 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008812 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8813 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8814 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8815 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8816
8817 Supported in default-server: No
8818
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008819ciphers <ciphers>
8820 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008821 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008822 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8823 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8824 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8825 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8826 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8827 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8828
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008829 Supported in default-server: No
8830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008831cookie <value>
8832 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8833 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8834 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8835 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8836 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8837 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8838 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8839
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008840 Supported in default-server: No
8841
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008842crl-file <crlfile>
8843 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8844 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8845 to verify server's certificate.
8846
8847 Supported in default-server: No
8848
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008849crt <cert>
8850 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8851 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8852 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8853 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8854 certificate request.
8855
8856 Supported in default-server: No
8857
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008858disabled
8859 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8860 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8861 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8862 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8863 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8864
8865 Supported in default-server: No
8866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008867error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008868 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8869 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8870 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008871
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008872 Supported in default-server: Yes
8873
8874 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008875
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008876fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008877 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8878 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8879 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8880
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008881 Supported in default-server: Yes
8882
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008883force-sslv3
8884 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8885 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008886 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8887 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008888
8889 Supported in default-server: No
8890
8891force-tlsv10
8892 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008893 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8894 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008895
8896 Supported in default-server: No
8897
8898force-tlsv11
8899 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008900 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8901 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008902
8903 Supported in default-server: No
8904
8905force-tlsv12
8906 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008907 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8908 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008909
8910 Supported in default-server: No
8911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008912id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008913 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8914 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8915 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008916
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008917 Supported in default-server: No
8918
8919inter <delay>
8920fastinter <delay>
8921downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008922 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8923 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8924 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8925 between checks depending on the server state :
8926
8927 Server state | Interval used
8928 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8929 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8930 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8931 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8932 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8933 or yet unchecked. |
8934 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8935 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8936 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008938 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8939 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8940 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8941 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008942 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8943 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8944 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8945 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8946 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008947
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008948 Supported in default-server: Yes
8949
8950maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008951 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8952 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8953 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8954 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8955 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8956 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8957 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8958 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8959
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008960 Supported in default-server: Yes
8961
8962maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008963 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8964 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8965 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8966 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8967 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8968 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8969 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008971 Supported in default-server: Yes
8972
8973minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008974 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8975 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8976 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8977 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8978 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8979 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008980 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008981 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008982
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008983 Supported in default-server: Yes
8984
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008985no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008986 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8987 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008988 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008989
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008990 Supported in default-server: No
8991
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008992no-tls-tickets
8993 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8994 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8995 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008996 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
8997 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008998
8999 Supported in default-server: No
9000
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009001no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009002 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009003 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9004 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009005 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9006 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9007 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009008
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009009 Supported in default-server: No
9010
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009011no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009012 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009013 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9014 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009015 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9016 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9017 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009018
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009019 Supported in default-server: No
9020
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009021no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009022 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009023 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9024 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009025 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9026 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9027 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009028
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009029 Supported in default-server: No
9030
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009031non-stick
9032 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9033 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9034 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9035
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009036 Supported in default-server: No
9037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009038observe <mode>
9039 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9040 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9041 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9042 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9043 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9044 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009045 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009047 Supported in default-server: No
9048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009049 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9050
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009051on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009052 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9053 Currently, four modes are available:
9054 - fastinter: force fastinter
9055 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9056 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9057 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9058 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9059
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009060 Supported in default-server: Yes
9061
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009062 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9063
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009064on-marked-down <action>
9065 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9066 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009067 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9068 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9069 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9070 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9071 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9072 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9073 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9074 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009075
9076 Actions are disabled by default
9077
9078 Supported in default-server: Yes
9079
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009080on-marked-up <action>
9081 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9082 Currently one action is available:
9083 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9084 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9085 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9086 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9087 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9088 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9089 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9090 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9091
9092 Actions are disabled by default
9093
9094 Supported in default-server: Yes
9095
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009096port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009097 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9098 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9099 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9100 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9101 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9102 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9103
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009104 Supported in default-server: Yes
9105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009106redir <prefix>
9107 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9108 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9109 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9110 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9111 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9112 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9113 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9114 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009115 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009116 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9117 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9118 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9119 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9120 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9121
9122 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9123
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009124 Supported in default-server: No
9125
9126rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009127 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9128 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9129 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9130
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009131 Supported in default-server: Yes
9132
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009133send-proxy
9134 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9135 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9136 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9137 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9138 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9139 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9140 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9141 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9142 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009143 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9144 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9145 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9146 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9147 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009148
9149 Supported in default-server: No
9150
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009151send-proxy-v2
9152 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9153 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9154 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9155 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9156 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9157 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9158 option of the "bind" keyword.
9159
9160 Supported in default-server: No
9161
9162send-proxy-v2-ssl
9163 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9164 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9165 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9166 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9167 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9168 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9169 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9170 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9171
9172 Supported in default-server: No
9173
9174send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9175 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9176 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9177 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9178 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9179 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9180 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9181 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9182 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9183 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9184
9185 Supported in default-server: No
9186
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009187slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009188 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9189 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9190 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9191 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9192 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9193 parameters :
9194
9195 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9196 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9197
9198 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9199 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9200 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9201 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9202
9203 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9204 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9205 seen as failed.
9206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009207 Supported in default-server: Yes
9208
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009209source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009210source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009211source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009212 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9213 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9214 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9215 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9216
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009217 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9218 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9219 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9220 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9221 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9222 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9223 server.
9224
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009225 Supported in default-server: No
9226
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009227ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009228 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9229 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9230 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9231 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9232 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9233 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009234 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009235
9236 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009237
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009238track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009239 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9240 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9241 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9242 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009243 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9244
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009245 Supported in default-server: No
9246
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009247verify [none|required]
9248 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009249 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9250 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9251 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9252 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009253 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9254 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9255 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009256
9257 Supported in default-server: No
9258
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009259verifyhost <hostname>
9260 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9261 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9262 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9263 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9264 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9265 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9266
9267 Supported in default-server: No
9268
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009269weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009270 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9271 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9272 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009273 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9274 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9275 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9276 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9277 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9278 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009279
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009280 Supported in default-server: Yes
9281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009282
92836. HTTP header manipulation
9284---------------------------
9285
9286In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9287response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9288request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9289which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009290against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009291
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009292If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9293to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9294but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9295HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9296stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9297because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9298a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9299still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009301This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9302in section 4.2 :
9303
9304 - reqadd <string>
9305 - reqallow <search>
9306 - reqiallow <search>
9307 - reqdel <search>
9308 - reqidel <search>
9309 - reqdeny <search>
9310 - reqideny <search>
9311 - reqpass <search>
9312 - reqipass <search>
9313 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9314 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9315 - reqtarpit <search>
9316 - reqitarpit <search>
9317 - rspadd <string>
9318 - rspdel <search>
9319 - rspidel <search>
9320 - rspdeny <search>
9321 - rspideny <search>
9322 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9323 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9324
9325With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9326is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9327parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9328prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9329Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9330
9331 \t for a tab
9332 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9333 \n for a new line (LF)
9334 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9335 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9336 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9337 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9338 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9339
9340The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9341portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9342above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9343regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
93449 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9345is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9346
9347The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9348after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9349
9350Notes related to these keywords :
9351---------------------------------
9352 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9353 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9354 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9355
9356 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9357 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9358 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9359
9360 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9361 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9362 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9363 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9364 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9365
9366 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9367 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9368 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9369 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9370 useless headers before adding new ones.
9371
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009372 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009373 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9374
9375 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9376 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9377 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9378
9379 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9380 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009381 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009382
9383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093847. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9385----------------------------------
9386
9387Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9388client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9389The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9390these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9391but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9392data called patterns.
9393
9394
93957.1. ACL basics
9396---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009397
9398The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9399content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9400from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9401simple :
9402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009403 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009404 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009405 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9406 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009408The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9409adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009410
9411In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009413 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009414
9415This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9416Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9417and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009418an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9419conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9420as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9421are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009422
9423ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9424'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9425which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9426
9427There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9428performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009430The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9431specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9432this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009433methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9434ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009435
9436Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9437 - boolean
9438 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9439 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9440 - string
9441 - data block
9442
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009443Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9444converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9445would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9446The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9447which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9448
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009449Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9450keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9451fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9452which are summarized in the table below :
9453
9454 +---------------------+-----------------+
9455 | Sample or converter | Default |
9456 | output type | matching method |
9457 +---------------------+-----------------+
9458 | boolean | bool |
9459 +---------------------+-----------------+
9460 | integer | int |
9461 +---------------------+-----------------+
9462 | ip | ip |
9463 +---------------------+-----------------+
9464 | string | str |
9465 +---------------------+-----------------+
9466 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9467 +---------------------+-----------------+
9468
9469Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9470matching method, see below.
9471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009472The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9473 - boolean
9474 - integer or integer range
9475 - IP address / network
9476 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9477 - regular expression
9478 - hex block
9479
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009480The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9481
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009482 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9483 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009484 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009485 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009486 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009487 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009488 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009490The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9491read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9492if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9493lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9494will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9495beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9496a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9497lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9498exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9499
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009500The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9501parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9502ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9503a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9504check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9505
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009506The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9507socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9508file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009510Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9511loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9512
9513 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9514
9515In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9516the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9517case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9518as well.
9519
9520The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9521sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9522do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9523methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9524is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9525obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9526followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9527default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9528that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9529string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9530
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009531The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9532By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9533string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9534resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9535server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9536waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9537flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9538function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009540There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9541sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9542be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009543
9544 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9545 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009546 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9547 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9548 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9549 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009550
9551 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9552 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009553 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009554
9555 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009556 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009557
9558 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009559 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009560
9561 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9562 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9563
9564 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9565 binary or string samples.
9566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009567 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9568 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009570 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9571 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9572 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009574 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9575 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009577 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9578 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009580 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9581 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009583 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9584 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009585 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009587 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9588 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9589 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009590
9591For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9592request, it is possible to do :
9593
9594 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9595
9596In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9597buffer, one would use the following acl :
9598
9599 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9600
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009601On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9602possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9603
9604 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009606All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9607criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9608method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9609to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9610criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9611the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009613If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009614the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9615For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009617 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9618 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9619 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9620 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009621
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009622
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009623The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9624types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9625combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9626brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9627default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009629 +-------------------------------------------------+
9630 | Input sample type |
9631 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009632 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009633 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9634 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9635 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009636 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009637 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009638 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009639 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009640 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009641 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009642 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009643 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009644 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009645 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009646 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009647 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009648 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009649 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009650 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009651 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009652 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009653 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009654 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009655 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009656 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009657 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9658 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9659 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009660
9661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096627.1.1. Matching booleans
9663------------------------
9664
9665In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9666Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9667When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9668that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9669
9670Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9671return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9672"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9673
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096757.1.2. Matching integers
9676------------------------
9677
9678Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9679enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9680to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9681
9682Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9683matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9684lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009685
9686For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9687unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9688representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9689
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009690As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9691two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9692instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9693ranges and operators.
9694
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009695For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009696operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9697Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9698of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009699
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009700Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009701
9702 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9703 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9704 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9705 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9706 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9707
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009708For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009709
9710 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9711
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009712This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9713
9714 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097177.1.3. Matching strings
9718-----------------------
9719
9720String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9721different forms :
9722
9723 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9724 patterns ;
9725
9726 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9727 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9728
9729 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9730 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9731
9732 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9733 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9734
9735 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9736 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9737 matches.
9738
9739 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9740 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9741 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009742
9743String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9744exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9745characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9746string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9747to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009748before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009749
9750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097517.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9752---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009753
9754Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9755they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9756possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9757passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9758the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009759the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9760match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009761
9762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097637.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9764-------------------------------------
9765
9766It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9767not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9768a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9769to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9770digits may be used upper or lower case.
9771
9772Example :
9773 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9774 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9775
9776
97777.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9778---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009779
9780IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9781netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9782within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009783host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009784difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9785at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9786does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9787parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009788
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009789IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9790Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9791trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9792IPv6 patterns.
9793
9794HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9795following situations :
9796 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9797 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9798 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9799 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9800 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9801 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9802 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9803 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9804 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9805 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009807
98087.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9809----------------------------------
9810
9811Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9812combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9813
9814 - AND (implicit)
9815 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9816 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009818A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009820 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009822Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9823indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009825For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9826"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9827requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9828is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9829
9830 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9831 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9832 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9833 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9834
9835To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9836and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9837
9838 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9839 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9840 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9841 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9842
9843 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9844 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9845 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9846 use_backend www if host_www
9847
9848It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9849expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9850be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9851the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9852
9853 The following rule :
9854
9855 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9856 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9857
9858 Can also be written that way :
9859
9860 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9861
9862It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9863to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9864simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9865sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9866good use is the following :
9867
9868 With named ACLs :
9869
9870 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9871 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9872 monitor fail if site_dead
9873
9874 With anonymous ACLs :
9875
9876 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9877
9878See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9879
9880
98817.3. Fetching samples
9882---------------------
9883
9884Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9885against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9886sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9887ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9888of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9889available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9890
9891This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9892Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9893compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9894deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9895
9896The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9897matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9898method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9899indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9900
9901As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9902when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9903mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9904the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9905ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9906
9907Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9908multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9909when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9910incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9911are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9912is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9913all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9914
9915Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9916 - name
9917 - name(arg1)
9918 - name(arg1,arg2)
9919
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009920
99217.3.1. Converters
9922-----------------
9923
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009924Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9925of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9926is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9927was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9928has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9929unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9930
9931These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9932sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9933the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9934support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009936The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009937
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009938base64
9939 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9940 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9941 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9942
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009943hex
9944 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9945 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9946 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9947 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009948
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009949http_date([<offset>])
9950 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9951 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9952 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9953 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9954 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9955 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009956
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +02009957ipmask(<mask>)
9958 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9959 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9960 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9961 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9962
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009963language(<value>[,<default>])
9964 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9965 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9966 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9967 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9968 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9969 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9970 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9971 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9972 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9973 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9974 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9975 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009976
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009977 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009978
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009979 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9980 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009981
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009982 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9983 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9984 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9985 use_backend spanish if es
9986 use_backend french if fr
9987 use_backend english if en
9988 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009989
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +02009990lower
9991 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9992 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9993 type. The result is of type string.
9994
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009995map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9996map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9997map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9998 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9999 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10000 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10001 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10002 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10003 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10004 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10005 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010006
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010007 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10008 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10009 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010010
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010011 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10012 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010013
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010014 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10015 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10016 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10017 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010018 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10019 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010020 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10021 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10022 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10023 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10024 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10025 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10026 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10027 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10028 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10029 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10030 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10031 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10032 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10033 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010034
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010035 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10036 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10037 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10038 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10039 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010040
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010041 Example :
10042
10043 # this is a comment and is ignored
10044 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10045 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10046 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10047 | | | `---------- value
10048 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10049 | `---------------------------- key
10050 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10051
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010052upper
10053 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10054 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10055 type. The result is of type string.
10056
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010057
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200100587.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010059--------------------------------------------
10060
10061A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10062not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10063"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10064The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10065
10066always_false : boolean
10067 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10068 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10069
10070always_true : boolean
10071 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10072 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10073
10074avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010075 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010076 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10077 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10078 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10079 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10080 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10081 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10082 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10083 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10084 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10085 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10086 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10087 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10088 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010090be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010091 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10092 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10093 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10094 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10095 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010097be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10098 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10099 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10100 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10101 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10102 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10103 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010104
10105 Example :
10106 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10107 backend dynamic
10108 mode http
10109 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10110 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010112connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10113 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010114 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010115 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10116 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010117
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010118 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010119 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010120 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10121
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010122 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10123 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010124
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010125 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010126 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010127 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010128 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10129 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010130 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010131 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010132
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010133 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10134 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010135 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010136 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010137
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010138date([<offset>]) : integer
10139 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10140 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10141 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10142 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010143 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10144
10145 Example :
10146
10147 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10148 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010149
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010150env(<name>) : string
10151 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10152 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10153 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10154 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10155 certain way.
10156
10157 Examples :
10158 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10159 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10160
10161 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10162 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010164fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10165 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010166 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10167 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010168 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10169 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10170 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10171 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10172 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010174fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10175 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10176 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10177 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10178 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10179 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10180 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10181 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10182 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010183
10184 Example :
10185 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10186 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10187 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10188 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10189 frontend mail
10190 bind :25
10191 mode tcp
10192 maxconn 100
10193 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10194 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10195 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10196 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010197
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010198nbproc : integer
10199 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
10200 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
10201 and debugging purposes.
10202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010203nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10204 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10205 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10206 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010207 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10208 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10209 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010210
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010211proc : integer
10212 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
10213 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
10214 debugging purposes.
10215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010216queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010217 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10218 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10219 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010220 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10221 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10222 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10223 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10224 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10225
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010226rand([<range>]) : integer
10227 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10228 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10229 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10230 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10231 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010233srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10234 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10235 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10236 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10237 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10238 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10239 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10240 methods.
10241
10242srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10243 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10244 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10245 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10246 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10247 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10248 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10249 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10250
10251srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10252 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10253 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010254 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010255 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10256 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10257 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10258 overloading servers).
10259
10260 Example :
10261 # Redirect to a separate back
10262 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10263 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10264 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10265
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010266stopping : boolean
10267 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
10268 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
10269 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
10270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010271table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10272 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10273 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10274
10275table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10276 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10277 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10278 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10279
10280
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200102817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010282----------------------------------
10283
10284The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10285closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10286methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10287sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10288TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010289the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10290counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10291"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010292argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10293the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10294this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010295
10296be_id : integer
10297 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10298 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10299
10300dst : ip
10301 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10302 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10303 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10304 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10305 RFC 4291.
10306
10307dst_conn : integer
10308 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10309 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10310 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10311 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10312 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10313 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10314 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10315 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010317dst_port : integer
10318 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10319 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10320 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10321 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10322 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10323 an HTTP header.
10324
10325fe_id : integer
10326 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10327 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10328 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10329
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010330sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010331sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10332sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10333sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010334 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10335 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10336 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10337
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010338sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010339sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10340sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10341sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010342 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10343 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10344 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10345
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010346sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010347sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10348sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10349sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010350 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10351 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010352 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10353 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10354 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010355
10356 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10357 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010358 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10359 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10360 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010361 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10362 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10363
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010364sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010365sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10366sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10367sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010368 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10369 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10370
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010371sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010372sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10373sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10374sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010375 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10376 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10377 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10378
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010379sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010380sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10381sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10382sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010383 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10384 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10385 See also src_conn_rate.
10386
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010387sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010388sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10389sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10390sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010391 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010392 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010393
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010394sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010395sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10396sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10397sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010398 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10399 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10400 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010401 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10402 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10403 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010404
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010405sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010406sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10407sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10408sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010409 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10410 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10411 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10412
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010413sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010414sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10415sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10416sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010417 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10418 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10419 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10420 src_http_err_rate.
10421
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010422sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010423sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10424sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10425sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010426 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10427 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10428 src_http_req_cnt.
10429
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010430sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010431sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10432sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10433sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010434 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10435 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10436 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10437 src_http_req_rate.
10438
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010439sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010440sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10441sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10442sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010443 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010444 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10445 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10446 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10447 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010448
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010449 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10450 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010451 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10452
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010453sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010454sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10455sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10456sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010457 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10458 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10459 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010460
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010461sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010462sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10463sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10464sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010465 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10466 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10467 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010468
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010469sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010470sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10471sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10472sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010473 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10474 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10475 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10476 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010477 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010478 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10479
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010480sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010481sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10482sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10483sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010484 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10485 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10486 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10487 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10488 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010489 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010490
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010491sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010492sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10493sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10494sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010495 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10496 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10497 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10498
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010499sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010500sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10501sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10502sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010503 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10504 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010505 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010506 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10507 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010508 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10509 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10510 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010512so_id : integer
10513 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10514 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10515 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010517src : ip
10518 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10519 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10520 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10521 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10522 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10523 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10524 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010525
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010526 Example:
10527 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10528 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010530src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10531 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10532 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10533 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010534 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010536src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10537 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10538 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010539 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010540 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010542src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10543 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10544 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10545 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10546 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10547 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10548 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010549
10550 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10551 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10552 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10553 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010554 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010555 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10556 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010558src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010559 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010560 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010561 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010562 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010564src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010565 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010566 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10567 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010568 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010570src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10571 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10572 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10573 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010574 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010576src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010577 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010578 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010579 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010580 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010582src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010583 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010584 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010585 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10586 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010587 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10588 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10589 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010591src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10592 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10593 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010594 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010595 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010596 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010598src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10599 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10600 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10601 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10602 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010603 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010605src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10606 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10607 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10608 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010609 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010611src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10612 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10613 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10614 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010615 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010616 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010618src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10619 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10620 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10621 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010622 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010623 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10624 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010625
10626 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010627 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010628 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010630src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010631 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
10632 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
10633 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
10634 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
10635 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010637src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010638 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
10639 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10640 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
10641 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10642 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010644src_port : integer
10645 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10646 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10647 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10648 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010650src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10651 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010652 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10653 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10654 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010655 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010657src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10658 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10659 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10660 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10661 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010662 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010664src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10665 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10666 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10667 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10668 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10669 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10670 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10671 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10672 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010673
10674 Example :
10675 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10676 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10677 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10678 listen ssh
10679 bind :22
10680 mode tcp
10681 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010682 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010683 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010684 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010686srv_id : integer
10687 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10688 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10689 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010690
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010691
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106927.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010693----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010695The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10696closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10697when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10698usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010699future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010700
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010701ssl_bc : boolean
10702 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10703 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10704 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10705
10706ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10707 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10708 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10709
10710ssl_bc_cipher : string
10711 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10712 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10713
10714ssl_bc_protocol : string
10715 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10716 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10717
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010718ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010719 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010720 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10721 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010722
10723ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10724 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10725 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10726 if session was reused or not.
10727
10728ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10729 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10730 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010732ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10733 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10734 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10735 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10736 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10737 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010739ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10740 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10741 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10742 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10743 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010744
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010745ssl_c_der : binary
10746 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
10747 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10748 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010750ssl_c_err : integer
10751 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10752 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10753 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10754 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10755 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010757ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10758 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10759 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10760 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10761 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10762 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10763 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10764 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10765 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010767ssl_c_key_alg : string
10768 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10769 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10770 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010772ssl_c_notafter : string
10773 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10774 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10775 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010777ssl_c_notbefore : string
10778 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10779 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10780 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010782ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10783 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10784 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10785 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10786 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10787 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10788 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10789 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10790 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010792ssl_c_serial : binary
10793 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10794 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10795 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010797ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10798 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10799 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10800 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau9fe4cb62014-07-02 19:01:22 +020010801 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
10802 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
10803
10804 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010806ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10807 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10808 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10809 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010811ssl_c_used : boolean
10812 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10813 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010815ssl_c_verify : integer
10816 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10817 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10818 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10819 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010821ssl_c_version : integer
10822 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10823 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010824
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010825ssl_f_der : binary
10826 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
10827 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10828 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010830ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10831 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10832 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10833 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10834 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010835 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010836 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10837 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10838 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010840ssl_f_key_alg : string
10841 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10842 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10843 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010845ssl_f_notafter : string
10846 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10847 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10848 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010850ssl_f_notbefore : string
10851 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10852 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10853 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010855ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10856 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10857 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10858 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10859 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10860 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10861 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10862 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10863 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010865ssl_f_serial : binary
10866 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10867 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10868 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010869
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010870ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10871 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10872 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10873 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010875ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10876 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10877 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10878 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010880ssl_f_version : integer
10881 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10882 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10883
10884ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010885 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10886 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10887 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010889 Example :
10890 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10891 listen http-https
10892 bind :80
10893 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10894 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10895
10896ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10897 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10898 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10899
10900ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010901 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010902 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10903 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10904 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10905 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10906 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10907 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10908 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10909 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010911ssl_fc_cipher : string
10912 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10913 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010915ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010916 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10917 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010918 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10919 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10920 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10921 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010923ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10924 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010925 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10926 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10927 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10928 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010930ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010931 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010932 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10933 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10934 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10935 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10936 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10937 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10938 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010940ssl_fc_protocol : string
10941 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10942 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010943
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010944ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010945 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010946 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10947 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010949ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10950 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10951 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10952 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10953 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010955ssl_fc_sni : string
10956 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10957 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10958 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10959 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10960 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10961
10962 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10963 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10964 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010965 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10966 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010968 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010969 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10970 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010972ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10973 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10974 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010975
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010976
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109777.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010978------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010980Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10981sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10982only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10983For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10984be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10985can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10986sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10987for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10988content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010990payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10991 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10992 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10993 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010995payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10996 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10997 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10998 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011000req.len : integer
11001req_len : integer (deprecated)
11002 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11003 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11004 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11005 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11006 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11007 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11008 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11009 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011011req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11012 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011013 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11014 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11015 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11016 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011018 ACL alternatives :
11019 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011021req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11022 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11023 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11024 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11025 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011027 ACL alternatives :
11028 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011030 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011032req.proto_http : boolean
11033req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11034 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11035 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11036 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11037 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11038 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11039 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11040 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011042 Example:
11043 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11044 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11045 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011046 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011048req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11049rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11050 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11051 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11052 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11053 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11054 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11055 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11056 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011058 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11059 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11060 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11061 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11062 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11063 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011065 ACL derivatives :
11066 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011068 Example :
11069 listen tse-farm
11070 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11071 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11072 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11073 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11074 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11075 persist rdp-cookie
11076 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11077 # This is only useful makes sense if
11078 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11079 stick-table type string size 204800
11080 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11081 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11082 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011084 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11085 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011087req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11088rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11089 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11090 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11091 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11092 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011094 ACL derivatives :
11095 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011097req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11098req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11099 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11100 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11101 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11102 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11103 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11104 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11105 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011107req.ssl_sni : string
11108req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11109 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11110 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11111 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11112 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11113 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11114 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11115 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11116 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11117 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11118 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11119 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11120 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011122 ACL derivatives :
11123 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011125 Examples :
11126 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11127 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11128 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11129 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11130 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011132res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11133rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11134 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11135 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11136 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11137 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11138 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11139 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11140 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011142req.ssl_ver : integer
11143req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11144 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11145 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11146 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11147 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11148 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11149 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11150 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11151 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11152 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011154 ACL derivatives :
11155 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011156
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011157res.len : integer
11158 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11159 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11160 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11161 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11162 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11163 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11164 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11165 content inspection.
11166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011167res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11168 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011169 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11170 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11171 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11172 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011174res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11175 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11176 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11177 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11178 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011180 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011182wait_end : boolean
11183 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11184 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11185 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11186 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11187 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11188 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11189 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11190 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011192 Examples :
11193 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11194 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11195 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011197 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11198 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11199 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11200 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11201 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11202 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11203 tcp-request content reject
11204
11205
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200112067.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011207--------------------------------------
11208
11209It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11210This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11211data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11212its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11213HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11214content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11215to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11216more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11217response are indexed.
11218
11219base : string
11220 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11221 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11222 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11223 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11224 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11225 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11226 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11227 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11228
11229 ACL derivatives :
11230 base : exact string match
11231 base_beg : prefix match
11232 base_dir : subdir match
11233 base_dom : domain match
11234 base_end : suffix match
11235 base_len : length match
11236 base_reg : regex match
11237 base_sub : substring match
11238
11239base32 : integer
11240 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11241 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11242 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11243 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11244
11245base32+src : binary
11246 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11247 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11248 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11249 per-URL counters.
11250
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011251capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11252 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11253 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11254 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11255
11256capture.req.method : string
11257 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11258 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11259 because it's allocated.
11260
11261capture.req.uri : string
11262 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11263 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11264 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11265 allocated.
11266
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011267capture.req.ver : string
11268 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11269 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11270 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11271
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011272capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11273 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11274 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11275 The first entry is an index of 0.
11276 See also: "capture response header"
11277
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011278capture.res.ver : string
11279 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11280 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11281 persistent flag.
11282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011283req.cook([<name>]) : string
11284cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11285 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11286 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11287 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11288 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11289 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11290 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11291 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11292 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11293
11294 ACL derivatives :
11295 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11296 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11297 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11298 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11299 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11300 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11301 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11302 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011304req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11305cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11306 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11307 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011309req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11310cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11311 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11312 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11313 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11314 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011316cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11317 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11318 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11319 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11320 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11321 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11322 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11323 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11324 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11325 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11326 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011328hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11329 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11330 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11331 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11332 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011333 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011335req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11336 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11337 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11338 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11339 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11340 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11341 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11342 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11343 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011345req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11346 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11347 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11348 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11349 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011351req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11352 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11353 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11354 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11355 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11356 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11357 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11358 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11359 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11360 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11361 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11362 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011364 ACL derivatives :
11365 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11366 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11367 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11368 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11369 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11370 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11371 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11372 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11373
11374req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11375hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11376 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11377 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11378 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11379 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11380 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11381 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11382 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11383 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11384 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11385
11386req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11387hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11388 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11389 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11390 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11391 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11392 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11393 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11394 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11395 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11396
11397req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11398hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11399 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11400 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11401 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11402 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11403 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11404 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11405 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11406
11407http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11408 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11409 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11410 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11411 basic auth is supported.
11412
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011413http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11414 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11415 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11416 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11417 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011418 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11419 basic auth is supported.
11420
11421 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011422 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11423 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11424 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11425 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011426
11427http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011428 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11429 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011430 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11431 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011433method : integer + string
11434 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11435 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11436 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11437 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11438 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11439 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11440 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011442 ACL derivatives :
11443 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011445 Example :
11446 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11447 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11448 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011450path : string
11451 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11452 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11453 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11454 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11455 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11456 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11457 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011459 ACL derivatives :
11460 path : exact string match
11461 path_beg : prefix match
11462 path_dir : subdir match
11463 path_dom : domain match
11464 path_end : suffix match
11465 path_len : length match
11466 path_reg : regex match
11467 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011469req.ver : string
11470req_ver : string (deprecated)
11471 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11472 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11473 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011475 ACL derivatives :
11476 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011478res.comp : boolean
11479 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11480 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11481 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011483res.comp_algo : string
11484 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11485 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11486 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011488res.cook([<name>]) : string
11489scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11490 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11491 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11492 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011494 ACL derivatives :
11495 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011497res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11498scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11499 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11500 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11501 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011503res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11504scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11505 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11506 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11507 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011509res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11510 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11511 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11512 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11513 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11514 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11515 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11516 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11517 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11518 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011520res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11521 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11522 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11523 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11524 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11525 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011527res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11528shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11529 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11530 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11531 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11532 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11533 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11534 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11535 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11536 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011538 ACL derivatives :
11539 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11540 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11541 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11542 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11543 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11544 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11545 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11546 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11547
11548res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11549shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11550 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11551 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11552 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11553 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11554 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011556res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11557shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11558 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11559 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11560 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11561 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11562 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11563 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011565res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11566shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11567 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11568 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11569 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11570 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11571 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11572 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011574res.ver : string
11575resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11576 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11577 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011579 ACL derivatives :
11580 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011582set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11583 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11584 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11585 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11586 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011588 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11589 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011591 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011593status : integer
11594 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11595 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11596 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011598url : string
11599 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11600 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11601 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11602 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11603 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11604 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11605 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011607 ACL derivatives :
11608 url : exact string match
11609 url_beg : prefix match
11610 url_dir : subdir match
11611 url_dom : domain match
11612 url_end : suffix match
11613 url_len : length match
11614 url_reg : regex match
11615 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011617url_ip : ip
11618 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11619 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11620 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11621 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11622 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11623 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11624 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011626url_port : integer
11627 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11628 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11629 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11630 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011632urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11633url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11634 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11635 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11636 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11637 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11638 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11639 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11640 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11641 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11642 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011644 ACL derivatives :
11645 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11646 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11647 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11648 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11649 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11650 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11651 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11652 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011653
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011655 Example :
11656 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11657 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11658 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11659 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011661urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11662 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11663 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11664 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011665
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116677.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011668---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011669
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011670Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11671every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011672order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011674ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11675---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011676FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011677HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011678HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11679HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011680HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11681HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11682HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11683HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11684LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011685METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11686METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11687METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11688METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11689METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11690METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011691RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011692REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011693TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011694WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11695---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011696
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116988. Logging
11699----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011700
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011701One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11702provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11703very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11704provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11705state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011706to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011707headers.
11708
11709In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11710about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11711send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11712
11713 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11714 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11715 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11716 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11717 at the termination.
11718
11719The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11720allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11721as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11722while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11723real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11724delay.
11725
11726
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117278.1. Log levels
11728---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011729
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011730TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011731source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011732HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11733in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11734track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11735syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11736about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011737
11738
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117398.2. Log formats
11740----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011741
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011742HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011743and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11744slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11745options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011746
11747 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11748 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11749 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11750 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11751 extents.
11752
11753 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11754 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11755 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11756 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11757 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11758
11759 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11760 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11761 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11762 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11763 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11764
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011765 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11766 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11767 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11768 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11769
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011770 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11771
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011772Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11773specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11774field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11775servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11776always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11777identifier.
11778
11779Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11780 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11781 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11782 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11783 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11784
11785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117868.2.1. Default log format
11787-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011788
11789This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11790as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11791format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11792
11793 Example :
11794 listen www
11795 mode http
11796 log global
11797 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11798
11799 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11800 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11801 (www/HTTP)
11802
11803 Field Format Extract from the example above
11804 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11805 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11806 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11807 4 'to' to
11808 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11809 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11810
11811Detailed fields description :
11812 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11813 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11814 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11815 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11816 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11817 and processed the connection.
11818 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11819
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011820In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11821"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11822connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11823
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011824It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11825will eventually disappear.
11826
11827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118288.2.2. TCP log format
11829---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011830
11831The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11832is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11833information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11834counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11835emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11836environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11837the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11838sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011839specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11840not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11841fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11842marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011843
11844 Example :
11845 frontend fnt
11846 mode tcp
11847 option tcplog
11848 log global
11849 default_backend bck
11850
11851 backend bck
11852 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11853
11854 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11855 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11856 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11857
11858 Field Format Extract from the example above
11859 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11860 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11861 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11862 4 frontend_name fnt
11863 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11864 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11865 7 bytes_read* 212
11866 8 termination_state --
11867 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11868 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11869
11870Detailed fields description :
11871 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011872 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11873 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11874 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11875 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11876 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011877
11878 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011879 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11880 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11881 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011882
11883 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11884 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11885 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11886 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11887
11888 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11889 and processed the connection.
11890
11891 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11892 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11893 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11894 applications.
11895
11896 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11897 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11898 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11899 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11900 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11901
11902 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11903 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11904 See "Timers" below for more details.
11905
11906 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11907 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11908 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11909 "Timers" below for more details.
11910
11911 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011912 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011913 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11914 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11915 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11916 details.
11917
11918 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11919 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11920 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11921 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11922 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11923
11924 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11925 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11926 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11927 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11928 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11929 for more details.
11930
11931 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011932 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011933 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11934 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11935 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011936 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011937
11938 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11939 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11940 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11941 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11942 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11943 caused by a denial of service attack.
11944
11945 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11946 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11947 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11948 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11949 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11950 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11951 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11952 denial of service attack.
11953
11954 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11955 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11956 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11957 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11958 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11959 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11960 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11961 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11962 be processed than on other servers.
11963
11964 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11965 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11966 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11967 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11968 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11969 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11970 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11971 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11972 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11973 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11974 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11975 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11976 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11977
11978 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11979 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11980 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11981 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11982 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11983 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11984 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11985 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11986
11987 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11988 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11989 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11990 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11991 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11992 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11993 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11994 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11995 occurs.
11996
11997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119988.2.3. HTTP log format
11999----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012000
12001The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12002is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12003the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12004are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12005emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12006generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12007"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12008which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012009frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12010is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012011
12012Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12013slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12014with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12015
12016 Example :
12017 frontend http-in
12018 mode http
12019 option httplog
12020 log global
12021 default_backend bck
12022
12023 backend static
12024 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12025
12026 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12027 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12028 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012029 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012030
12031 Field Format Extract from the example above
12032 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12033 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12034 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12035 4 frontend_name http-in
12036 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12037 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12038 7 status_code 200
12039 8 bytes_read* 2750
12040 9 captured_request_cookie -
12041 10 captured_response_cookie -
12042 11 termination_state ----
12043 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12044 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12045 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12046 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12047 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012048
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012049
12050Detailed fields description :
12051 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012052 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12053 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12054 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12055 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12056 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012057
12058 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012059 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12060 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12061 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012062
12063 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12064 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12065 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12066 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12067 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12068
12069 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12070 and processed the connection.
12071
12072 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12073 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12074 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12075
12076 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12077 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12078 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12079 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12080 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12081 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12082
12083 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12084 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12085 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12086 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12087 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12088 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12089
12090 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12091 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12092 See "Timers" below for more details.
12093
12094 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12095 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12096 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12097 below for more details.
12098
12099 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12100 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12101 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12102 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12103 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12104 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12105 for more details.
12106
12107 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012108 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012109 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12110 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12111 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12112 details.
12113
12114 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12115 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12116 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12117
12118 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12119 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12120 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12121 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12122 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12123 overflowing.
12124
12125 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12126 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12127 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12128 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12129 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12130 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12131 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12132 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12133
12134 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12135 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12136 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12137 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12138 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12139 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12140 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12141 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12142
12143 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12144 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12145 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12146 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12147 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12148 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12149 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12150
12151 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012152 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012153 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12154 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12155 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012156 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012157 system.
12158
12159 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12160 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12161 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12162 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12163 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12164 caused by a denial of service attack.
12165
12166 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12167 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12168 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12169 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12170 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12171 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12172 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12173 denial of service attack.
12174
12175 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12176 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12177 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12178 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12179 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12180 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12181 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12182 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12183 processed than on other servers.
12184
12185 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12186 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12187 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12188 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12189 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12190 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12191 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12192 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12193 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12194 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12195 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12196 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12197 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12198
12199 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12200 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12201 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12202 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12203 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12204 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12205 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12206 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12207
12208 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12209 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12210 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12211 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12212 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12213 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12214 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12215 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12216 occurs.
12217
12218 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12219 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12220 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12221 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12222 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12223 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12224 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12225 cookies" below for more details.
12226
12227 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12228 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12229 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12230 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12231 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12232 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12233 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12234 and cookies" below for more details.
12235
12236 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12237 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12238 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12239 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12240 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12241 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12242 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12243 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12244
12245
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200122468.2.4. Custom log format
12247------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012248
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012249The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012250mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012251
12252HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12253Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12254separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12255prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12256
12257Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12258variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12259string formats ("Q").
12260
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012261If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012262as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012263less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12264the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12265
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012266Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012267In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012268in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012269
12270Flags are :
12271 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012272 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012273
12274 Example:
12275
12276 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12277 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12278
12279At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12280
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012281 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12282 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012283
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012284the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012285
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012286 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012287 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012288 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012289
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012290and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12291
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012292 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012293 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12294
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012295Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12296
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012297 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012298 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012299 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12300 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12301 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012302 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12303 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12304 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012305 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012306 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012307 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012308 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012309 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012310 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012311 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12312 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012313 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012314 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12315 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012316 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012317 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12318 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012319 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12320 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12321 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012322 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012323 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12324 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012325 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012326 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12327 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12328 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012329 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012330 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12331 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12332 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12333 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012334 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012335 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012336 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012337 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012338 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012339 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012340 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12341 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12342 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012343 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012344 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12345 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012346 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012347 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012348 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012349 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012350
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012351 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012352
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012353
123548.2.5. Error log format
12355-----------------------
12356
12357When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12358protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12359By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12360"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12361will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12362logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12363
12364The format looks like this :
12365
12366 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12367 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12368 Connection error during SSL handshake
12369
12370 Field Format Extract from the example above
12371 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12372 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12373 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12374 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12375 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12376
12377These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12378failures.
12379
12380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123818.3. Advanced logging options
12382-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012383
12384Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12385just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12386options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12387for more information about their usage.
12388
12389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123908.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12391------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012392
12393It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12394haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12395commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12396monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12397ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12398
12399 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12400 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12401 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12402 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12403
12404 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12405 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12406 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012407 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012408 such as other load-balancers.
12409
12410 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12411 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12412 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12413
12414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124158.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12416----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012417
12418The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12419what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12420or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12421"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12422just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12423log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12424after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12425is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12426with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12427with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12428
12429
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124308.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12431------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012432
12433Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12434for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12435"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12436retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12437raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12438a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12439file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12440you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12441"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12442
12443
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124448.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12445--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012446
12447Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12448multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12449them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12450"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12451logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12452error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12453and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12454too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12455useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12456alternative.
12457
12458
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124598.4. Timing events
12460------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012461
12462Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12463reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12464the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12465frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12466mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12467
12468 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12469 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12470 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12471 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12472 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12473
12474 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12475 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12476 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12477 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12478 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12479
12480 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12481 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12482 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12483 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12484 connection never established.
12485
12486 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12487 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12488 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12489 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12490 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12491 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12492 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12493 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12494 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12495 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12496 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12497
12498 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12499 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12500 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12501 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012502 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012503
12504 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12505
12506 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12507 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12508 negative.
12509
12510These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12511protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12512that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012513due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012514close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12515session has been aborted on timeout.
12516
12517Most common cases :
12518
12519 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12520 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12521 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12522 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12523 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12524 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12525 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12526 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12527 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012528 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12529 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12530 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012531
12532 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12533 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12534 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12535 of ms on remote networks.
12536
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012537 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12538 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12539 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012540
12541 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12542 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12543 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12544 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12545 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12546 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12547 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12548 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12549 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12550 to the server until another one is released.
12551
12552Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12553
12554 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12555 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12556 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12557
12558 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12559 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12560 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12561
12562 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12563 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12564 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12565 flags.
12566
12567 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12568 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12569 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12570 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12571 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12572 the client connection was maintained open.
12573
12574 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012575 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012576 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12577 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12578
12579
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125808.5. Session state at disconnection
12581-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012582
12583TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12584"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
125852-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12586each of which has a special meaning :
12587
12588 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12589 session to terminate :
12590
12591 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12592
12593 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12594 server explicitly refused it.
12595
12596 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12597 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12598 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12599 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012600 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12601
12602 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12603 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012604
12605 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12606 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12607 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12608 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12609 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12610
12611 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12612 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12613 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12614 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12615 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12616
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012617 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12618 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12619
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012620 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12621 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12622 backup connections when going up.
12623
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012624 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12625
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012626 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12627 send or receive data.
12628
12629 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12630 send or receive data.
12631
12632 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12633 with nothing left in the buffers.
12634
12635 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12636
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012637 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012638 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12639
12640 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12641 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12642 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12643 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12644 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12645
12646 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12647 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12648
12649 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12650 server (HTTP only).
12651
12652 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12653
12654 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12655 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12656 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12657
12658 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12659 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12660 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12661
12662 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12663
12664 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12665 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12666
12667 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12668 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12669 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12670
12671 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12672 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012673 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12674 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012675
12676 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12677 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12678 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12679 another server.
12680
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012681 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012682 server.
12683
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012684 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12685 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12686 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12687 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12688
12689 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12690 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12691 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12692 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12693
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012694 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12695 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12696 "use-server" rule).
12697
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012698 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12699
12700 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12701 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12702
12703 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12704
12705 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12706 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12707 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12708
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012709 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12710 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012711 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012712 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12713 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12714
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012715 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12716
12717 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12718 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12719
12720 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12721
12722 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12723
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012724The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12725was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012726helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12727starvation, attacks, etc...
12728
12729The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12730alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12731easier finding and understanding.
12732
12733 Flags Reason
12734
12735 -- Normal termination.
12736
12737 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12738 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12739 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12740 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12741
12742 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12743 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12744 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12745 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12746 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12747 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012748
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012749 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12750 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012751 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012752
12753 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12754 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12755 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12756
12757 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12758 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12759 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12760 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12761 the server takes too long to respond.
12762
12763 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12764 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12765 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12766 long a time to respond.
12767
12768 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12769 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12770 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12771 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12772 and the client.
12773
12774 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12775 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12776 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12777 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12778 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012779 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
12780 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
12781 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
12782 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
12783 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
12784 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
12785 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
12786 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
12787 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
12788 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
12789 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
12790 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
12791 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
12792 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012793
12794 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12795 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012796 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12797 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12798 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12799 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012800
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012801 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12802 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12803
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012804 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012805 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12806 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12807 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12808 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12809 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12810
12811 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12812 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12813 503 or 504 here.
12814
12815 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12816 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12817 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12818 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12819 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12820
12821 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12822 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012823 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012824 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12825 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12826
12827 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12828 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12829 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12830 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12831 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12832 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12833 between haproxy and the server.
12834
12835 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12836 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12837 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12838 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12839 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12840 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12841 solution is to fix the application.
12842
12843 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12844 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12845 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12846 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12847 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12848 external attacks.
12849
12850 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12851 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012852 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012853 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12854 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12855
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012856 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12857 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12858 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012859 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12860 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012861
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012862 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12863 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12864 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12865 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012866 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12867 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12868 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12869 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12870 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012871
12872 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12873 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12874 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12875 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12876
12877 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12878 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12879 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12880 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12881
12882 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12883 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12884 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12885 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12886
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012887The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12888persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12889important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12890re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12891
12892 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12893
12894 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12895 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12896 set on a GET request.
12897
12898 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12899 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012900 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012901 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12902
12903 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12904 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12905 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12906
12907 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12908 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12909 already got a cookie.
12910
12911 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12912 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12913 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12914 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12915 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12916
12917 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12918 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12919 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12920
12921 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12922 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12923 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12924
12925 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12926 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12927
12928 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12929 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12930 then advertised in the response.
12931
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012932
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129338.6. Non-printable characters
12934-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012935
12936In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12937consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12938converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12939prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12940being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12941escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12942is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12943'}' when logging headers.
12944
12945Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12946issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12947containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12948
12949Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12950the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12951performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12952
12953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129548.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12955---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012956
12957Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12958achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012959section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012960cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12961the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12962the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012963locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012964not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12965user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12966a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12967wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12968
12969 Examples :
12970 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12971 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12972
12973 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12974 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12975
12976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129778.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12978---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012979
12980Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12981proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12982the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12983server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12984
12985Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12986response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012987section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012988
12989It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012990time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12991appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012992are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12993and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12994follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12995request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12996in the logs.
12997
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012998As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
12999frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13000an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13001
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013002 Example :
13003 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13004 listen proxy-out
13005 mode http
13006 option httplog
13007 option logasap
13008 log global
13009 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13010
13011 # log the name of the virtual server
13012 capture request header Host len 20
13013
13014 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13015 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13016
13017 # log the beginning of the referrer
13018 capture request header Referer len 20
13019
13020 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13021 capture response header Server len 20
13022
13023 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13024 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13025
13026 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13027 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13028
13029 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13030 capture response header Via len 20
13031
13032 # log the URL location during a redirection
13033 capture response header Location len 20
13034
13035 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13036 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13037 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13038 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13039 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13040
13041 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13042 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13043 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13044 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013045 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013046
13047 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13048 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13049 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13050 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13051 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013052 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013053
13054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130558.9. Examples of logs
13056---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013057
13058These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13059them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13060reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13061
13062 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13063 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13064 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13065
13066 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13067 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13068
13069 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13070 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13071 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13072
13073 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13074 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13075
13076 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13077 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13078 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13079
13080 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013081 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013082 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13083 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13084
13085 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13086 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13087 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13088
13089 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13090 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013091 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013092 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13093 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13094 to return the 502 and not the server.
13095
13096 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013097 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013098
13099 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13100 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13101 Nothing was sent to any server.
13102
13103 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13104 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13105
13106 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13107 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13108 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13109 send a 408 return code to the client.
13110
13111 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13112 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13113
13114 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13115 5 seconds ("c----").
13116
13117 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13118 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013119 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013120
13121 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013122 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013123 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13124 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13125 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13126 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13127 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013128
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131309. Statistics and monitoring
13131----------------------------
13132
13133It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13134mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13135CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13136Unix socket.
13137
13138
131399.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013140---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013141
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013142The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013143page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13144begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13145represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13146use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13147('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13148(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13149text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13150do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13151use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013152
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013153In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13154that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13155S (Servers).
13156
13157 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13158 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13159 any name for server/listener)
13160 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13161 number queued without a server assigned.
13162 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13163 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13164 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13165 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13166 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13167 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13168 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13169 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13170 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13171 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13172 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13173 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13174 "option checkcache".
13175 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13176 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13177 - read error from the client
13178 - client timeout
13179 - client closed connection
13180 - various bad requests from the client.
13181 - request was tarpitted.
13182 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13183 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13184 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13185 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13186 active servers).
13187 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13188 Some other errors are:
13189 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13190 - failure applying filters to the response.
13191 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13192 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13193 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13194 switched away from.
13195 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13196 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13197 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13198 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13199 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13200 the server is up.)
13201 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13202 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13203 counters for each server.
13204 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13205 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13206 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13207 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13208 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13209 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13210 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13211 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13212 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13213 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13214 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13215 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13216 of times that server was selected.
13217 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13218 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13219 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13220 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13221 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13222 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013223 UNK -> unknown
13224 INI -> initializing
13225 SOCKERR -> socket error
13226 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harveycac41222015-04-16 11:13:21 -080013227 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013228 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13229 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13230 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13231 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13232 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13233 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13234 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13235 disable-on-404
13236 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13237 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13238 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013239 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13240 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13241 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13242 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13243 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13244 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13245 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13246 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13247 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13248 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13249 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13250 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13251 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13252 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13253 (inc. in eresp)
13254 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13255 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13256 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13257 (CPU/BW limit)
13258 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13259 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13260 server/backend
13261 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13262 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13263 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13264 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13265 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13266 (0 for TCP)
13267 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13268 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013269
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132719.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013272-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013273
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013274The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13275necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13276A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13277issuing commands by hand :
13278
13279 global
13280 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13281 stats timeout 2m
13282
13283It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13284the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13285never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13286situations :
13287
13288 global
13289 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13290 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13291 stats timeout 2m
13292
13293To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13294swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13295to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13296syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13297
13298 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13299 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13300
13301The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13302script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13303for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13304
13305The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13306that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13307editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13308(eg: watch a counter).
13309
13310The socket supports two operation modes :
13311 - interactive
13312 - non-interactive
13313
13314The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13315this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13316sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13317mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13318commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13319example :
13320
13321 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13322
13323The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13324entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13325for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13326sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13327"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13328after processing the last command of the same line.
13329
13330For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13331"prompt" command :
13332
13333 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13334 prompt
13335 > show info
13336 ...
13337 >
13338
13339Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13340delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13341that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13342parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013343
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013344It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13345on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13346own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013347
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013348The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13349If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13350all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13351it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13352
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013353add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013354 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13355 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13356 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13357 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013358
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013359add map <map> <key> <value>
13360 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13361 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013362 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13363 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13364 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013365
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013366clear counters
13367 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13368 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13369 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13370 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13371 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13372
13373clear counters all
13374 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13375 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13376 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13377
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013378clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013379 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13380 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13381 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013382
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013383clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013384 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13385 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13386 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013387
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013388clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13389 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13390
13391 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13392 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13393 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13394 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13395 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13396 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13397
13398 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13399
13400 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13401 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13402 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13403 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13404 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13405 the ACLs :
13406
13407 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13408 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13409 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13410 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13411 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13412 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13413
13414 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013415 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13416 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013417
13418 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013419 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013420 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013421 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13422 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13423 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13424 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013425
13426 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13427
13428 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013429 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013430 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13431 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013432 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13433 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13434 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013435
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013436del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13437 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013438 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13439 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13440 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13441 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013442
13443del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013444 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013445 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13446 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13447 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13448 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013449
13450disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013451 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13452
13453 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13454 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13455 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13456 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13457 re-enabled using enable agent.
13458
13459 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13460 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13461 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13462 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13463 otherwise unchanged.
13464
13465 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13466 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13467 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13468
13469 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13470 level "admin".
13471
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013472disable frontend <frontend>
13473 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13474 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13475 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13476 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13477 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13478 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13479 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13480 on the stats page.
13481
13482 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13483 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13484
13485 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13486 level "admin".
13487
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013488disable health <backend>/<server>
13489 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13490 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13491 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13492 agent check forces it down.
13493
13494 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13495 level "admin".
13496
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013497disable server <backend>/<server>
13498 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13499 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13500 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13501 during the maintenance.
13502
13503 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13504 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13505
13506 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013507 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013508
13509 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13510 level "admin".
13511
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013512enable agent <backend>/<server>
13513 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13514
13515 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13516 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13517
13518 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13519 level "admin".
13520
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013521enable frontend <frontend>
13522 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13523 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13524 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13525 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13526 which was disabled.
13527
13528 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13529 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13530
13531 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13532 level "admin".
13533
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013534enable health <backend>/<server>
13535 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13536 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13537
13538 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13539 level "admin".
13540
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013541enable server <backend>/<server>
13542 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13543 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13544
13545 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013546 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013547
13548 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13549 level "admin".
13550
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013551get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013552get acl <acl> <value>
13553 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13554 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13555 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13556 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13557 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013558
13559 The first two words are:
13560
13561 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13562 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13563 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13564
13565 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13566
13567 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13568
13569 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13570
13571 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13572 interpretation of the case.
13573
13574 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13575 useful with regular expressions.
13576
13577 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13578 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13579
13580 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13581 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13582 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13583
13584 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13585
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013586get weight <backend>/<server>
13587 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13588 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13589 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13590 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13591 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013592 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013593
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013594help
13595 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13596 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013597
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013598prompt
13599 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13600 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13601 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13602 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13603 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13604 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13605 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13606 command.
13607
13608quit
13609 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013610
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013611set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013612 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13613 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13614 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013615
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013616set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013617 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13618 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13619 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13620 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13621 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013622 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13623 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13624
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013625set maxconn global <maxconn>
13626 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13627 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13628 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13629 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13630 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13631 setting.
13632
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013633set rate-limit connections global <value>
13634 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13635 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13636 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13637 is passed in number of connections per second.
13638
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013639set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13640 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13641 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013642 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13643 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013644
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013645set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13646 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13647 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13648 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13649 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13650
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013651set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13652 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13653 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13654 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13655 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13656 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13657
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013658set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13659 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13660 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13661 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13662
13663set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13664 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13665 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13666 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13667
13668set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13669 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13670 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13671 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13672 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13673 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13674 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13675 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13676 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13677
13678set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13679 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13680 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13681
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013682set ssl ocsp-response <response>
13683 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
13684 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
13685 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
13686 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
13687
13688 Example:
13689 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
13690 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
13691 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
13692 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
13693
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013694set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013695 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13696 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13697 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13698 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013699 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13700 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013701
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013702set timeout cli <delay>
13703 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13704 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13705 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13706
13707set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13708 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13709 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013710 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13711 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13712 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13713 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13714 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13715 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13716 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13717 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13718 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13719 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13720 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13721 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13722 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013723
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013724show errors [<iid>]
13725 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13726 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013727 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13728 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13729 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013730
13731 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13732 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13733 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13734 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13735 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13736 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13737 are reported too.
13738
13739 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13740 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13741 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13742 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13743 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13744 code.
13745
13746 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13747 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13748 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13749 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13750 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13751 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13752 line.
13753
13754 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013755 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13756 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013757 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13758 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13759
13760 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13761 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13762 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13763 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13764 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13765 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13766 00204+ minal\r\n
13767 00211 \r\n
13768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013769 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013770 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13771 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13772 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13773 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13774 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13775 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013776
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013777show info
13778 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13779
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013780show map [<map>]
13781 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013782 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13783 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13784 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13785 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13786 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13787 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013788
13789show acl [<acl>]
13790 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013791 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13792 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13793 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13794 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13795 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013796
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013797show pools
13798 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13799 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13800 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13801 the pools.
13802
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013803show sess
13804 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013805 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13806 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13807
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013808show sess <id>
13809 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13810 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13811 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13812 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13813 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Oliviere99d44d2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020013814 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
13815 returned in src/dumpstats.c
13816
13817 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
13818 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013819
13820show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13821 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13822 possible to dump only selected items :
13823 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13824 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13825 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13826 for example:
13827 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13828 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13829 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13830
13831 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013832 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13833 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013834 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13835 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13836 Nbproc: 1
13837 Process_num: 1
13838 (...)
13839
13840 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13841 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13842 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13843 (...)
13844 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13845
13846 $
13847
13848 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13849 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13850 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13851 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013852 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013853
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013854show table
13855 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13856 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13857 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13858 entries currently in use.
13859
13860 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013861 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013862 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13863 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013864
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013865show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013866 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13867 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13868 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013869 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13870
13871 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13872 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13873 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13874 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13875 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13876
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013877 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13878 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13879 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13880 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13881 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13882 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13883
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013884
13885 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013886 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13887 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013888
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013889 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013890 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013891 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013892 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13893 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13894 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13895 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013896
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013897 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013898 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013899 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13900 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013901
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013902 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13903 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013904 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013905 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13906 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013907
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013908 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13909 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013910 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013911 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13912 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13913
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013914 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13915 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13916 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13917 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13918 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13919
13920 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13921 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13922 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013923 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13924 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013925 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13926 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013927
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013928shutdown frontend <frontend>
13929 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13930 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13931 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13932 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13933 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13934 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13935 once it is terminated.
13936
13937 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13938 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13939
13940 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13941 level "admin".
13942
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013943shutdown session <id>
13944 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13945 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13946 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13947 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13948 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13949 flag in the logs.
13950
Cyril Bontéde9789b2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020013951shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013952 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13953 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13954 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13955 'K' flag in the logs.
13956
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013957/*
13958 * Local variables:
13959 * fill-column: 79
13960 * End:
13961 */